]> git.proxmox.com Git - mirror_ubuntu-jammy-kernel.git/blob - include/net/mac80211.h
Merge tag 'kvm-s390-next-5.15-1' of git://git.kernel.org/pub/scm/linux/kernel/git...
[mirror_ubuntu-jammy-kernel.git] / include / net / mac80211.h
1 /* SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-only */
2 /*
3 * mac80211 <-> driver interface
4 *
5 * Copyright 2002-2005, Devicescape Software, Inc.
6 * Copyright 2006-2007 Jiri Benc <jbenc@suse.cz>
7 * Copyright 2007-2010 Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net>
8 * Copyright 2013-2014 Intel Mobile Communications GmbH
9 * Copyright (C) 2015 - 2017 Intel Deutschland GmbH
10 * Copyright (C) 2018 - 2021 Intel Corporation
11 */
12
13 #ifndef MAC80211_H
14 #define MAC80211_H
15
16 #include <linux/bug.h>
17 #include <linux/kernel.h>
18 #include <linux/if_ether.h>
19 #include <linux/skbuff.h>
20 #include <linux/ieee80211.h>
21 #include <net/cfg80211.h>
22 #include <net/codel.h>
23 #include <net/ieee80211_radiotap.h>
24 #include <asm/unaligned.h>
25
26 /**
27 * DOC: Introduction
28 *
29 * mac80211 is the Linux stack for 802.11 hardware that implements
30 * only partial functionality in hard- or firmware. This document
31 * defines the interface between mac80211 and low-level hardware
32 * drivers.
33 */
34
35 /**
36 * DOC: Calling mac80211 from interrupts
37 *
38 * Only ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() can be
39 * called in hardware interrupt context. The low-level driver must not call any
40 * other functions in hardware interrupt context. If there is a need for such
41 * call, the low-level driver should first ACK the interrupt and perform the
42 * IEEE 802.11 code call after this, e.g. from a scheduled workqueue or even
43 * tasklet function.
44 *
45 * NOTE: If the driver opts to use the _irqsafe() functions, it may not also
46 * use the non-IRQ-safe functions!
47 */
48
49 /**
50 * DOC: Warning
51 *
52 * If you're reading this document and not the header file itself, it will
53 * be incomplete because not all documentation has been converted yet.
54 */
55
56 /**
57 * DOC: Frame format
58 *
59 * As a general rule, when frames are passed between mac80211 and the driver,
60 * they start with the IEEE 802.11 header and include the same octets that are
61 * sent over the air except for the FCS which should be calculated by the
62 * hardware.
63 *
64 * There are, however, various exceptions to this rule for advanced features:
65 *
66 * The first exception is for hardware encryption and decryption offload
67 * where the IV/ICV may or may not be generated in hardware.
68 *
69 * Secondly, when the hardware handles fragmentation, the frame handed to
70 * the driver from mac80211 is the MSDU, not the MPDU.
71 */
72
73 /**
74 * DOC: mac80211 workqueue
75 *
76 * mac80211 provides its own workqueue for drivers and internal mac80211 use.
77 * The workqueue is a single threaded workqueue and can only be accessed by
78 * helpers for sanity checking. Drivers must ensure all work added onto the
79 * mac80211 workqueue should be cancelled on the driver stop() callback.
80 *
81 * mac80211 will flushed the workqueue upon interface removal and during
82 * suspend.
83 *
84 * All work performed on the mac80211 workqueue must not acquire the RTNL lock.
85 *
86 */
87
88 /**
89 * DOC: mac80211 software tx queueing
90 *
91 * mac80211 provides an optional intermediate queueing implementation designed
92 * to allow the driver to keep hardware queues short and provide some fairness
93 * between different stations/interfaces.
94 * In this model, the driver pulls data frames from the mac80211 queue instead
95 * of letting mac80211 push them via drv_tx().
96 * Other frames (e.g. control or management) are still pushed using drv_tx().
97 *
98 * Drivers indicate that they use this model by implementing the .wake_tx_queue
99 * driver operation.
100 *
101 * Intermediate queues (struct ieee80211_txq) are kept per-sta per-tid, with
102 * another per-sta for non-data/non-mgmt and bufferable management frames, and
103 * a single per-vif queue for multicast data frames.
104 *
105 * The driver is expected to initialize its private per-queue data for stations
106 * and interfaces in the .add_interface and .sta_add ops.
107 *
108 * The driver can't access the queue directly. To dequeue a frame from a
109 * txq, it calls ieee80211_tx_dequeue(). Whenever mac80211 adds a new frame to a
110 * queue, it calls the .wake_tx_queue driver op.
111 *
112 * Drivers can optionally delegate responsibility for scheduling queues to
113 * mac80211, to take advantage of airtime fairness accounting. In this case, to
114 * obtain the next queue to pull frames from, the driver calls
115 * ieee80211_next_txq(). The driver is then expected to return the txq using
116 * ieee80211_return_txq().
117 *
118 * For AP powersave TIM handling, the driver only needs to indicate if it has
119 * buffered packets in the driver specific data structures by calling
120 * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(). For frames buffered in the ieee80211_txq
121 * struct, mac80211 sets the appropriate TIM PVB bits and calls
122 * .release_buffered_frames().
123 * In that callback the driver is therefore expected to release its own
124 * buffered frames and afterwards also frames from the ieee80211_txq (obtained
125 * via the usual ieee80211_tx_dequeue).
126 */
127
128 struct device;
129
130 /**
131 * enum ieee80211_max_queues - maximum number of queues
132 *
133 * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES: Maximum number of regular device queues.
134 * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP: bitmap with maximum queues set
135 */
136 enum ieee80211_max_queues {
137 IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES = 16,
138 IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP = BIT(IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES) - 1,
139 };
140
141 #define IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE 0xff
142
143 /**
144 * enum ieee80211_ac_numbers - AC numbers as used in mac80211
145 * @IEEE80211_AC_VO: voice
146 * @IEEE80211_AC_VI: video
147 * @IEEE80211_AC_BE: best effort
148 * @IEEE80211_AC_BK: background
149 */
150 enum ieee80211_ac_numbers {
151 IEEE80211_AC_VO = 0,
152 IEEE80211_AC_VI = 1,
153 IEEE80211_AC_BE = 2,
154 IEEE80211_AC_BK = 3,
155 };
156
157 /**
158 * struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params - transmit queue configuration
159 *
160 * The information provided in this structure is required for QoS
161 * transmit queue configuration. Cf. IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.29.
162 *
163 * @aifs: arbitration interframe space [0..255]
164 * @cw_min: minimum contention window [a value of the form
165 * 2^n-1 in the range 1..32767]
166 * @cw_max: maximum contention window [like @cw_min]
167 * @txop: maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning disabled
168 * @acm: is mandatory admission control required for the access category
169 * @uapsd: is U-APSD mode enabled for the queue
170 * @mu_edca: is the MU EDCA configured
171 * @mu_edca_param_rec: MU EDCA Parameter Record for HE
172 */
173 struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params {
174 u16 txop;
175 u16 cw_min;
176 u16 cw_max;
177 u8 aifs;
178 bool acm;
179 bool uapsd;
180 bool mu_edca;
181 struct ieee80211_he_mu_edca_param_ac_rec mu_edca_param_rec;
182 };
183
184 struct ieee80211_low_level_stats {
185 unsigned int dot11ACKFailureCount;
186 unsigned int dot11RTSFailureCount;
187 unsigned int dot11FCSErrorCount;
188 unsigned int dot11RTSSuccessCount;
189 };
190
191 /**
192 * enum ieee80211_chanctx_change - change flag for channel context
193 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH: The channel width changed
194 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS: The number of RX chains changed
195 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR: radar detection flag changed
196 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL: switched to another operating channel,
197 * this is used only with channel switching with CSA
198 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_WIDTH: The min required channel width changed
199 */
200 enum ieee80211_chanctx_change {
201 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH = BIT(0),
202 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS = BIT(1),
203 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR = BIT(2),
204 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL = BIT(3),
205 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_WIDTH = BIT(4),
206 };
207
208 /**
209 * struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf - channel context that vifs may be tuned to
210 *
211 * This is the driver-visible part. The ieee80211_chanctx
212 * that contains it is visible in mac80211 only.
213 *
214 * @def: the channel definition
215 * @min_def: the minimum channel definition currently required.
216 * @rx_chains_static: The number of RX chains that must always be
217 * active on the channel to receive MIMO transmissions
218 * @rx_chains_dynamic: The number of RX chains that must be enabled
219 * after RTS/CTS handshake to receive SMPS MIMO transmissions;
220 * this will always be >= @rx_chains_static.
221 * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled on this channel.
222 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
223 * sizeof(void *), size is determined in hw information.
224 */
225 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf {
226 struct cfg80211_chan_def def;
227 struct cfg80211_chan_def min_def;
228
229 u8 rx_chains_static, rx_chains_dynamic;
230
231 bool radar_enabled;
232
233 u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
234 };
235
236 /**
237 * enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode - channel context switch mode
238 * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF: Both old and new contexts already
239 * exist (and will continue to exist), but the virtual interface
240 * needs to be switched from one to the other.
241 * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS: The old context exists but will stop
242 * to exist with this call, the new context doesn't exist but
243 * will be active after this call, the virtual interface switches
244 * from the old to the new (note that the driver may of course
245 * implement this as an on-the-fly chandef switch of the existing
246 * hardware context, but the mac80211 pointer for the old context
247 * will cease to exist and only the new one will later be used
248 * for changes/removal.)
249 */
250 enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode {
251 CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF,
252 CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS,
253 };
254
255 /**
256 * struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch - vif chanctx switch information
257 *
258 * This is structure is used to pass information about a vif that
259 * needs to switch from one chanctx to another. The
260 * &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode defines how the switch should be
261 * done.
262 *
263 * @vif: the vif that should be switched from old_ctx to new_ctx
264 * @old_ctx: the old context to which the vif was assigned
265 * @new_ctx: the new context to which the vif must be assigned
266 */
267 struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch {
268 struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
269 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *old_ctx;
270 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *new_ctx;
271 };
272
273 /**
274 * enum ieee80211_bss_change - BSS change notification flags
275 *
276 * These flags are used with the bss_info_changed() callback
277 * to indicate which BSS parameter changed.
278 *
279 * @BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC: association status changed (associated/disassociated),
280 * also implies a change in the AID.
281 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT: CTS protection changed
282 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE: preamble changed
283 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT: slot timing changed
284 * @BSS_CHANGED_HT: 802.11n parameters changed
285 * @BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES: Basic rateset changed
286 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT: Beacon interval changed
287 * @BSS_CHANGED_BSSID: BSSID changed, for whatever
288 * reason (IBSS and managed mode)
289 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON: Beacon data changed, retrieve
290 * new beacon (beaconing modes)
291 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED: Beaconing should be
292 * enabled/disabled (beaconing modes)
293 * @BSS_CHANGED_CQM: Connection quality monitor config changed
294 * @BSS_CHANGED_IBSS: IBSS join status changed
295 * @BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER: Hardware ARP filter address list or state changed.
296 * @BSS_CHANGED_QOS: QoS for this association was enabled/disabled. Note
297 * that it is only ever disabled for station mode.
298 * @BSS_CHANGED_IDLE: Idle changed for this BSS/interface.
299 * @BSS_CHANGED_SSID: SSID changed for this BSS (AP and IBSS mode)
300 * @BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP: Probe Response changed for this BSS (AP mode)
301 * @BSS_CHANGED_PS: PS changed for this BSS (STA mode)
302 * @BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER: TX power setting changed for this interface
303 * @BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS: P2P powersave settings (CTWindow, opportunistic PS)
304 * changed
305 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO: Data from the AP's beacon became available:
306 * currently dtim_period only is under consideration.
307 * @BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH: The bandwidth used by this interface changed,
308 * note that this is only called when it changes after the channel
309 * context had been assigned.
310 * @BSS_CHANGED_OCB: OCB join status changed
311 * @BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS: VHT MU-MIMO group id or user position changed
312 * @BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE: keep alive options (idle period or protected
313 * keep alive) changed.
314 * @BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE: Multicast Rate setting changed for this interface
315 * @BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER: fine timing measurement request responder
316 * functionality changed for this BSS (AP mode).
317 * @BSS_CHANGED_TWT: TWT status changed
318 * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD: OBSS Packet Detection status changed.
319 * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR: BSS Color has changed
320 * @BSS_CHANGED_FILS_DISCOVERY: FILS discovery status changed.
321 * @BSS_CHANGED_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Unsolicited broadcast probe response
322 * status changed.
323 *
324 */
325 enum ieee80211_bss_change {
326 BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC = 1<<0,
327 BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT = 1<<1,
328 BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE = 1<<2,
329 BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT = 1<<3,
330 BSS_CHANGED_HT = 1<<4,
331 BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES = 1<<5,
332 BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT = 1<<6,
333 BSS_CHANGED_BSSID = 1<<7,
334 BSS_CHANGED_BEACON = 1<<8,
335 BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED = 1<<9,
336 BSS_CHANGED_CQM = 1<<10,
337 BSS_CHANGED_IBSS = 1<<11,
338 BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER = 1<<12,
339 BSS_CHANGED_QOS = 1<<13,
340 BSS_CHANGED_IDLE = 1<<14,
341 BSS_CHANGED_SSID = 1<<15,
342 BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP = 1<<16,
343 BSS_CHANGED_PS = 1<<17,
344 BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER = 1<<18,
345 BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS = 1<<19,
346 BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO = 1<<20,
347 BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH = 1<<21,
348 BSS_CHANGED_OCB = 1<<22,
349 BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS = 1<<23,
350 BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE = 1<<24,
351 BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE = 1<<25,
352 BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER = 1<<26,
353 BSS_CHANGED_TWT = 1<<27,
354 BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD = 1<<28,
355 BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR = 1<<29,
356 BSS_CHANGED_FILS_DISCOVERY = 1<<30,
357 BSS_CHANGED_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP = 1<<31,
358
359 /* when adding here, make sure to change ieee80211_reconfig */
360 };
361
362 /*
363 * The maximum number of IPv4 addresses listed for ARP filtering. If the number
364 * of addresses for an interface increase beyond this value, hardware ARP
365 * filtering will be disabled.
366 */
367 #define IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN 4
368
369 /**
370 * enum ieee80211_event_type - event to be notified to the low level driver
371 * @RSSI_EVENT: AP's rssi crossed the a threshold set by the driver.
372 * @MLME_EVENT: event related to MLME
373 * @BAR_RX_EVENT: a BAR was received
374 * @BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT: Frames were released from the reordering buffer because
375 * they timed out. This won't be called for each frame released, but only
376 * once each time the timeout triggers.
377 */
378 enum ieee80211_event_type {
379 RSSI_EVENT,
380 MLME_EVENT,
381 BAR_RX_EVENT,
382 BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT,
383 };
384
385 /**
386 * enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data - relevant when event type is %RSSI_EVENT
387 * @RSSI_EVENT_HIGH: AP's rssi went below the threshold set by the driver.
388 * @RSSI_EVENT_LOW: AP's rssi went above the threshold set by the driver.
389 */
390 enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data {
391 RSSI_EVENT_HIGH,
392 RSSI_EVENT_LOW,
393 };
394
395 /**
396 * struct ieee80211_rssi_event - data attached to an %RSSI_EVENT
397 * @data: See &enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data
398 */
399 struct ieee80211_rssi_event {
400 enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data data;
401 };
402
403 /**
404 * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT
405 * @AUTH_EVENT: the MLME operation is authentication
406 * @ASSOC_EVENT: the MLME operation is association
407 * @DEAUTH_RX_EVENT: deauth received..
408 * @DEAUTH_TX_EVENT: deauth sent.
409 */
410 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data {
411 AUTH_EVENT,
412 ASSOC_EVENT,
413 DEAUTH_RX_EVENT,
414 DEAUTH_TX_EVENT,
415 };
416
417 /**
418 * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT
419 * @MLME_SUCCESS: the MLME operation completed successfully.
420 * @MLME_DENIED: the MLME operation was denied by the peer.
421 * @MLME_TIMEOUT: the MLME operation timed out.
422 */
423 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status {
424 MLME_SUCCESS,
425 MLME_DENIED,
426 MLME_TIMEOUT,
427 };
428
429 /**
430 * struct ieee80211_mlme_event - data attached to an %MLME_EVENT
431 * @data: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data
432 * @status: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status
433 * @reason: the reason code if applicable
434 */
435 struct ieee80211_mlme_event {
436 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data data;
437 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status status;
438 u16 reason;
439 };
440
441 /**
442 * struct ieee80211_ba_event - data attached for BlockAck related events
443 * @sta: pointer to the &ieee80211_sta to which this event relates
444 * @tid: the tid
445 * @ssn: the starting sequence number (for %BAR_RX_EVENT)
446 */
447 struct ieee80211_ba_event {
448 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
449 u16 tid;
450 u16 ssn;
451 };
452
453 /**
454 * struct ieee80211_event - event to be sent to the driver
455 * @type: The event itself. See &enum ieee80211_event_type.
456 * @rssi: relevant if &type is %RSSI_EVENT
457 * @mlme: relevant if &type is %AUTH_EVENT
458 * @ba: relevant if &type is %BAR_RX_EVENT or %BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT
459 * @u:union holding the fields above
460 */
461 struct ieee80211_event {
462 enum ieee80211_event_type type;
463 union {
464 struct ieee80211_rssi_event rssi;
465 struct ieee80211_mlme_event mlme;
466 struct ieee80211_ba_event ba;
467 } u;
468 };
469
470 /**
471 * struct ieee80211_mu_group_data - STA's VHT MU-MIMO group data
472 *
473 * This structure describes the group id data of VHT MU-MIMO
474 *
475 * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group
476 * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group
477 */
478 struct ieee80211_mu_group_data {
479 u8 membership[WLAN_MEMBERSHIP_LEN];
480 u8 position[WLAN_USER_POSITION_LEN];
481 };
482
483 /**
484 * struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params - FTM responder parameters
485 *
486 * @lci: LCI subelement content
487 * @civicloc: CIVIC location subelement content
488 * @lci_len: LCI data length
489 * @civicloc_len: Civic data length
490 */
491 struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params {
492 const u8 *lci;
493 const u8 *civicloc;
494 size_t lci_len;
495 size_t civicloc_len;
496 };
497
498 /**
499 * struct ieee80211_fils_discovery - FILS discovery parameters from
500 * IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail.
501 *
502 * @min_interval: Minimum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
503 * @max_interval: Maximum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
504 */
505 struct ieee80211_fils_discovery {
506 u32 min_interval;
507 u32 max_interval;
508 };
509
510 /**
511 * struct ieee80211_bss_conf - holds the BSS's changing parameters
512 *
513 * This structure keeps information about a BSS (and an association
514 * to that BSS) that can change during the lifetime of the BSS.
515 *
516 * @htc_trig_based_pkt_ext: default PE in 4us units, if BSS supports HE
517 * @multi_sta_back_32bit: supports BA bitmap of 32-bits in Multi-STA BACK
518 * @uora_exists: is the UORA element advertised by AP
519 * @ack_enabled: indicates support to receive a multi-TID that solicits either
520 * ACK, BACK or both
521 * @uora_ocw_range: UORA element's OCW Range field
522 * @frame_time_rts_th: HE duration RTS threshold, in units of 32us
523 * @he_support: does this BSS support HE
524 * @twt_requester: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed
525 * mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role)
526 * @twt_responder: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed
527 * mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role)
528 * @twt_protected: does this BSS support protected TWT frames
529 * @twt_broadcast: does this BSS support broadcast TWT
530 * @assoc: association status
531 * @ibss_joined: indicates whether this station is part of an IBSS
532 * or not
533 * @ibss_creator: indicates if a new IBSS network is being created
534 * @aid: association ID number, valid only when @assoc is true
535 * @use_cts_prot: use CTS protection
536 * @use_short_preamble: use 802.11b short preamble
537 * @use_short_slot: use short slot time (only relevant for ERP)
538 * @dtim_period: num of beacons before the next DTIM, for beaconing,
539 * valid in station mode only if after the driver was notified
540 * with the %BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO flag, will be non-zero then.
541 * @sync_tsf: last beacon's/probe response's TSF timestamp (could be old
542 * as it may have been received during scanning long ago). If the
543 * HW flag %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY is set, then this can
544 * only come from a beacon, but might not become valid until after
545 * association when a beacon is received (which is notified with the
546 * %BSS_CHANGED_DTIM flag.). See also sync_dtim_count important notice.
547 * @sync_device_ts: the device timestamp corresponding to the sync_tsf,
548 * the driver/device can use this to calculate synchronisation
549 * (see @sync_tsf). See also sync_dtim_count important notice.
550 * @sync_dtim_count: Only valid when %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY
551 * is requested, see @sync_tsf/@sync_device_ts.
552 * IMPORTANT: These three sync_* parameters would possibly be out of sync
553 * by the time the driver will use them. The synchronized view is currently
554 * guaranteed only in certain callbacks.
555 * @beacon_int: beacon interval
556 * @assoc_capability: capabilities taken from assoc resp
557 * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates, each bit stands for an
558 * index into the rate table configured by the driver in
559 * the current band.
560 * @beacon_rate: associated AP's beacon TX rate
561 * @mcast_rate: per-band multicast rate index + 1 (0: disabled)
562 * @bssid: The BSSID for this BSS
563 * @enable_beacon: whether beaconing should be enabled or not
564 * @chandef: Channel definition for this BSS -- the hardware might be
565 * configured a higher bandwidth than this BSS uses, for example.
566 * @mu_group: VHT MU-MIMO group membership data
567 * @ht_operation_mode: HT operation mode like in &struct ieee80211_ht_operation.
568 * This field is only valid when the channel is a wide HT/VHT channel.
569 * Note that with TDLS this can be the case (channel is HT, protection must
570 * be used from this field) even when the BSS association isn't using HT.
571 * @cqm_rssi_thold: Connection quality monitor RSSI threshold, a zero value
572 * implies disabled. As with the cfg80211 callback, a change here should
573 * cause an event to be sent indicating where the current value is in
574 * relation to the newly configured threshold.
575 * @cqm_rssi_low: Connection quality monitor RSSI lower threshold, a zero value
576 * implies disabled. This is an alternative mechanism to the single
577 * threshold event and can't be enabled simultaneously with it.
578 * @cqm_rssi_high: Connection quality monitor RSSI upper threshold.
579 * @cqm_rssi_hyst: Connection quality monitor RSSI hysteresis
580 * @arp_addr_list: List of IPv4 addresses for hardware ARP filtering. The
581 * may filter ARP queries targeted for other addresses than listed here.
582 * The driver must allow ARP queries targeted for all address listed here
583 * to pass through. An empty list implies no ARP queries need to pass.
584 * @arp_addr_cnt: Number of addresses currently on the list. Note that this
585 * may be larger than %IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN (the arp_addr_list
586 * array size), it's up to the driver what to do in that case.
587 * @qos: This is a QoS-enabled BSS.
588 * @idle: This interface is idle. There's also a global idle flag in the
589 * hardware config which may be more appropriate depending on what
590 * your driver/device needs to do.
591 * @ps: power-save mode (STA only). This flag is NOT affected by
592 * offchannel/dynamic_ps operations.
593 * @ssid: The SSID of the current vif. Valid in AP and IBSS mode.
594 * @ssid_len: Length of SSID given in @ssid.
595 * @hidden_ssid: The SSID of the current vif is hidden. Only valid in AP-mode.
596 * @txpower: TX power in dBm. INT_MIN means not configured.
597 * @txpower_type: TX power adjustment used to control per packet Transmit
598 * Power Control (TPC) in lower driver for the current vif. In particular
599 * TPC is enabled if value passed in %txpower_type is
600 * NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED (allow using less than specified from
601 * userspace), whereas TPC is disabled if %txpower_type is set to
602 * NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED (use value configured from userspace)
603 * @p2p_noa_attr: P2P NoA attribute for P2P powersave
604 * @allow_p2p_go_ps: indication for AP or P2P GO interface, whether it's allowed
605 * to use P2P PS mechanism or not. AP/P2P GO is not allowed to use P2P PS
606 * if it has associated clients without P2P PS support.
607 * @max_idle_period: the time period during which the station can refrain from
608 * transmitting frames to its associated AP without being disassociated.
609 * In units of 1000 TUs. Zero value indicates that the AP did not include
610 * a (valid) BSS Max Idle Period Element.
611 * @protected_keep_alive: if set, indicates that the station should send an RSN
612 * protected frame to the AP to reset the idle timer at the AP for the
613 * station.
614 * @ftm_responder: whether to enable or disable fine timing measurement FTM
615 * responder functionality.
616 * @ftmr_params: configurable lci/civic parameter when enabling FTM responder.
617 * @nontransmitted: this BSS is a nontransmitted BSS profile
618 * @transmitter_bssid: the address of transmitter AP
619 * @bssid_index: index inside the multiple BSSID set
620 * @bssid_indicator: 2^bssid_indicator is the maximum number of APs in set
621 * @ema_ap: AP supports enhancements of discovery and advertisement of
622 * nontransmitted BSSIDs
623 * @profile_periodicity: the least number of beacon frames need to be received
624 * in order to discover all the nontransmitted BSSIDs in the set.
625 * @he_oper: HE operation information of the BSS (AP/Mesh) or of the AP we are
626 * connected to (STA)
627 * @he_obss_pd: OBSS Packet Detection parameters.
628 * @he_bss_color: BSS coloring settings, if BSS supports HE
629 * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery configuration
630 * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp_interval: Unsolicited broadcast probe response
631 * interval.
632 * @s1g: BSS is S1G BSS (affects Association Request format).
633 * @beacon_tx_rate: The configured beacon transmit rate that needs to be passed
634 * to driver when rate control is offloaded to firmware.
635 */
636 struct ieee80211_bss_conf {
637 const u8 *bssid;
638 u8 htc_trig_based_pkt_ext;
639 bool uora_exists;
640 u8 uora_ocw_range;
641 u16 frame_time_rts_th;
642 bool he_support;
643 bool twt_requester;
644 bool twt_responder;
645 bool twt_protected;
646 bool twt_broadcast;
647 /* association related data */
648 bool assoc, ibss_joined;
649 bool ibss_creator;
650 u16 aid;
651 /* erp related data */
652 bool use_cts_prot;
653 bool use_short_preamble;
654 bool use_short_slot;
655 bool enable_beacon;
656 u8 dtim_period;
657 u16 beacon_int;
658 u16 assoc_capability;
659 u64 sync_tsf;
660 u32 sync_device_ts;
661 u8 sync_dtim_count;
662 u32 basic_rates;
663 struct ieee80211_rate *beacon_rate;
664 int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
665 u16 ht_operation_mode;
666 s32 cqm_rssi_thold;
667 u32 cqm_rssi_hyst;
668 s32 cqm_rssi_low;
669 s32 cqm_rssi_high;
670 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
671 struct ieee80211_mu_group_data mu_group;
672 __be32 arp_addr_list[IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN];
673 int arp_addr_cnt;
674 bool qos;
675 bool idle;
676 bool ps;
677 u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
678 size_t ssid_len;
679 bool hidden_ssid;
680 int txpower;
681 enum nl80211_tx_power_setting txpower_type;
682 struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr p2p_noa_attr;
683 bool allow_p2p_go_ps;
684 u16 max_idle_period;
685 bool protected_keep_alive;
686 bool ftm_responder;
687 struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params *ftmr_params;
688 /* Multiple BSSID data */
689 bool nontransmitted;
690 u8 transmitter_bssid[ETH_ALEN];
691 u8 bssid_index;
692 u8 bssid_indicator;
693 bool ema_ap;
694 u8 profile_periodicity;
695 struct {
696 u32 params;
697 u16 nss_set;
698 } he_oper;
699 struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd he_obss_pd;
700 struct cfg80211_he_bss_color he_bss_color;
701 struct ieee80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery;
702 u32 unsol_bcast_probe_resp_interval;
703 bool s1g;
704 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_tx_rate;
705 };
706
707 /**
708 * enum mac80211_tx_info_flags - flags to describe transmission information/status
709 *
710 * These flags are used with the @flags member of &ieee80211_tx_info.
711 *
712 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS: require TX status callback for this frame.
713 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ: The driver has to assign a sequence
714 * number to this frame, taking care of not overwriting the fragment
715 * number and increasing the sequence number only when the
716 * IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT flag is set. mac80211 will properly
717 * assign sequence numbers to QoS-data frames but cannot do so correctly
718 * for non-QoS-data and management frames because beacons need them from
719 * that counter as well and mac80211 cannot guarantee proper sequencing.
720 * If this flag is set, the driver should instruct the hardware to
721 * assign a sequence number to the frame or assign one itself. Cf. IEEE
722 * 802.11-2007 7.1.3.4.1 paragraph 3. This flag will always be set for
723 * beacons and always be clear for frames without a sequence number field.
724 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK: tell the low level not to wait for an ack
725 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT: clear powersave filter for destination
726 * station
727 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT: this is a first fragment of the frame
728 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM: send this frame after DTIM beacon
729 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU: this frame should be sent as part of an A-MPDU
730 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED: Frame was injected, internal to mac80211.
731 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED: The frame was not transmitted
732 * because the destination STA was in powersave mode. Note that to
733 * avoid race conditions, the filter must be set by the hardware or
734 * firmware upon receiving a frame that indicates that the station
735 * went to sleep (must be done on device to filter frames already on
736 * the queue) and may only be unset after mac80211 gives the OK for
737 * that by setting the IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT (see above),
738 * since only then is it guaranteed that no more frames are in the
739 * hardware queue.
740 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK: Frame was acknowledged
741 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU: The frame was aggregated, so status
742 * is for the whole aggregation.
743 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK: no block ack was returned,
744 * so consider using block ack request (BAR).
745 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE: internal to mac80211, can be
746 * set by rate control algorithms to indicate probe rate, will
747 * be cleared for fragmented frames (except on the last fragment)
748 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK: Internal to mac80211. Used to indicate
749 * that a frame can be transmitted while the queues are stopped for
750 * off-channel operation.
751 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP: This frame uses hardware encapsulation
752 * (header conversion)
753 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED: completely internal to mac80211,
754 * used to indicate that a frame was already retried due to PS
755 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT: completely internal to mac80211,
756 * used to indicate frame should not be encrypted
757 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER: This frame is a response to a poll
758 * frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD) or a non-bufferable MMPDU and must
759 * be sent although the station is in powersave mode.
760 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES: More frames will be passed to the
761 * transmit function after the current frame, this can be used
762 * by drivers to kick the DMA queue only if unset or when the
763 * queue gets full.
764 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION: This frame is being retransmitted
765 * after TX status because the destination was asleep, it must not
766 * be modified again (no seqno assignment, crypto, etc.)
767 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX: This frame was transmitted by the MLME
768 * code for connection establishment, this indicates that its status
769 * should kick the MLME state machine.
770 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX: Frame was requested through nl80211
771 * MLME command (internal to mac80211 to figure out whether to send TX
772 * status to user space)
773 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC: tells the driver to use LDPC for this frame
774 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC: Enables Space-Time Block Coding (STBC) for this
775 * frame and selects the maximum number of streams that it can use.
776 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN: Marks this packet to be transmitted on
777 * the off-channel channel when a remain-on-channel offload is done
778 * in hardware -- normal packets still flow and are expected to be
779 * handled properly by the device.
780 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE: Marks this packet to be used for TKIP
781 * testing. It will be sent out with incorrect Michael MIC key to allow
782 * TKIP countermeasures to be tested.
783 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE: This frame will be sent at non CCK rate.
784 * This flag is actually used for management frame especially for P2P
785 * frames not being sent at CCK rate in 2GHz band.
786 * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP: This packet marks the end of service period,
787 * when its status is reported the service period ends. For frames in
788 * an SP that mac80211 transmits, it is already set; for driver frames
789 * the driver may set this flag. It is also used to do the same for
790 * PS-Poll responses.
791 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE: This frame will be sent at lowest rate.
792 * This flag is used to send nullfunc frame at minimum rate when
793 * the nullfunc is used for connection monitoring purpose.
794 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG: Don't fragment this packet even if it
795 * would be fragmented by size (this is optional, only used for
796 * monitor injection).
797 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED: A frame that was marked with
798 * IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK has been successfully transmitted without
799 * any errors (like issues specific to the driver/HW).
800 * This flag must not be set for frames that don't request no-ack
801 * behaviour with IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK.
802 *
803 * Note: If you have to add new flags to the enumeration, then don't
804 * forget to update %IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS when necessary.
805 */
806 enum mac80211_tx_info_flags {
807 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS = BIT(0),
808 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ = BIT(1),
809 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK = BIT(2),
810 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT = BIT(3),
811 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT = BIT(4),
812 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM = BIT(5),
813 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU = BIT(6),
814 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED = BIT(7),
815 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED = BIT(8),
816 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK = BIT(9),
817 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU = BIT(10),
818 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK = BIT(11),
819 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE = BIT(12),
820 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK = BIT(13),
821 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP = BIT(14),
822 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED = BIT(15),
823 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT = BIT(16),
824 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER = BIT(17),
825 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES = BIT(18),
826 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION = BIT(19),
827 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX = BIT(20),
828 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX = BIT(21),
829 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC = BIT(22),
830 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC = BIT(23) | BIT(24),
831 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN = BIT(25),
832 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE = BIT(26),
833 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE = BIT(27),
834 IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP = BIT(28),
835 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE = BIT(29),
836 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG = BIT(30),
837 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED = BIT(31),
838 };
839
840 #define IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC_SHIFT 23
841
842 #define IEEE80211_TX_RC_S1G_MCS IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS
843
844 /**
845 * enum mac80211_tx_control_flags - flags to describe transmit control
846 *
847 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO: this frame is a port control
848 * protocol frame (e.g. EAP)
849 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE: This frame is a response to a poll
850 * frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD).
851 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT: This frame is injected with rate information
852 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU: This frame is an A-MSDU frame
853 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT: This frame is going through the fast_xmit path
854 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP: This frame skips mesh path lookup
855 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTCFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING: completely internal to mac80211,
856 * used to indicate that a pending frame requires TX processing before
857 * it can be sent out.
858 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO: Do not overwrite the sequence number that
859 * has already been assigned to this frame.
860 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_REORDER: This frame should not be reordered
861 * relative to other frames that have this flag set, independent
862 * of their QoS TID or other priority field values.
863 *
864 * These flags are used in tx_info->control.flags.
865 */
866 enum mac80211_tx_control_flags {
867 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO = BIT(0),
868 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE = BIT(1),
869 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT = BIT(2),
870 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU = BIT(3),
871 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT = BIT(4),
872 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP = BIT(5),
873 IEEE80211_TX_INTCFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING = BIT(6),
874 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO = BIT(7),
875 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_REORDER = BIT(8),
876 };
877
878 /*
879 * This definition is used as a mask to clear all temporary flags, which are
880 * set by the tx handlers for each transmission attempt by the mac80211 stack.
881 */
882 #define IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS (IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK | \
883 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT | \
884 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU | \
885 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED | IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK | \
886 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU | IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK | \
887 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER | \
888 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC | \
889 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC | IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP)
890
891 /**
892 * enum mac80211_rate_control_flags - per-rate flags set by the
893 * Rate Control algorithm.
894 *
895 * These flags are set by the Rate control algorithm for each rate during tx,
896 * in the @flags member of struct ieee80211_tx_rate.
897 *
898 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS: Use RTS/CTS exchange for this rate.
899 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT: CTS-to-self protection is required.
900 * This is set if the current BSS requires ERP protection.
901 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE: Use short preamble.
902 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS: HT rate.
903 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS: VHT MCS rate, in this case the idx field is split
904 * into a higher 4 bits (Nss) and lower 4 bits (MCS number)
905 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD: Indicates whether this rate should be used in
906 * Greenfield mode.
907 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates if the Channel Width should be 40 MHz.
908 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 80 MHz transmission
909 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 160 MHz transmission
910 * (80+80 isn't supported yet)
911 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA: The frame should be transmitted on both of the
912 * adjacent 20 MHz channels, if the current channel type is
913 * NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS or NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS.
914 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI: Short Guard interval should be used for this rate.
915 */
916 enum mac80211_rate_control_flags {
917 IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS = BIT(0),
918 IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT = BIT(1),
919 IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE = BIT(2),
920
921 /* rate index is an HT/VHT MCS instead of an index */
922 IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS = BIT(3),
923 IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD = BIT(4),
924 IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH = BIT(5),
925 IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA = BIT(6),
926 IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI = BIT(7),
927 IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS = BIT(8),
928 IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH = BIT(9),
929 IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH = BIT(10),
930 };
931
932
933 /* there are 40 bytes if you don't need the rateset to be kept */
934 #define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 40
935
936 /* if you do need the rateset, then you have less space */
937 #define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 24
938
939 /* maximum number of rate stages */
940 #define IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES 4
941
942 /* maximum number of rate table entries */
943 #define IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE 4
944
945 /**
946 * struct ieee80211_tx_rate - rate selection/status
947 *
948 * @idx: rate index to attempt to send with
949 * @flags: rate control flags (&enum mac80211_rate_control_flags)
950 * @count: number of tries in this rate before going to the next rate
951 *
952 * A value of -1 for @idx indicates an invalid rate and, if used
953 * in an array of retry rates, that no more rates should be tried.
954 *
955 * When used for transmit status reporting, the driver should
956 * always report the rate along with the flags it used.
957 *
958 * &struct ieee80211_tx_info contains an array of these structs
959 * in the control information, and it will be filled by the rate
960 * control algorithm according to what should be sent. For example,
961 * if this array contains, in the format { <idx>, <count> } the
962 * information::
963 *
964 * { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 4 }, { -1, 0 }, { -1, 0 }
965 *
966 * then this means that the frame should be transmitted
967 * up to twice at rate 3, up to twice at rate 2, and up to four
968 * times at rate 1 if it doesn't get acknowledged. Say it gets
969 * acknowledged by the peer after the fifth attempt, the status
970 * information should then contain::
971 *
972 * { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 1 }, { -1, 0 } ...
973 *
974 * since it was transmitted twice at rate 3, twice at rate 2
975 * and once at rate 1 after which we received an acknowledgement.
976 */
977 struct ieee80211_tx_rate {
978 s8 idx;
979 u16 count:5,
980 flags:11;
981 } __packed;
982
983 #define IEEE80211_MAX_TX_RETRY 31
984
985 static inline void ieee80211_rate_set_vht(struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate,
986 u8 mcs, u8 nss)
987 {
988 WARN_ON(mcs & ~0xF);
989 WARN_ON((nss - 1) & ~0x7);
990 rate->idx = ((nss - 1) << 4) | mcs;
991 }
992
993 static inline u8
994 ieee80211_rate_get_vht_mcs(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
995 {
996 return rate->idx & 0xF;
997 }
998
999 static inline u8
1000 ieee80211_rate_get_vht_nss(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1001 {
1002 return (rate->idx >> 4) + 1;
1003 }
1004
1005 /**
1006 * struct ieee80211_tx_info - skb transmit information
1007 *
1008 * This structure is placed in skb->cb for three uses:
1009 * (1) mac80211 TX control - mac80211 tells the driver what to do
1010 * (2) driver internal use (if applicable)
1011 * (3) TX status information - driver tells mac80211 what happened
1012 *
1013 * @flags: transmit info flags, defined above
1014 * @band: the band to transmit on (use for checking for races)
1015 * @hw_queue: HW queue to put the frame on, skb_get_queue_mapping() gives the AC
1016 * @ack_frame_id: internal frame ID for TX status, used internally
1017 * @tx_time_est: TX time estimate in units of 4us, used internally
1018 * @control: union part for control data
1019 * @control.rates: TX rates array to try
1020 * @control.rts_cts_rate_idx: rate for RTS or CTS
1021 * @control.use_rts: use RTS
1022 * @control.use_cts_prot: use RTS/CTS
1023 * @control.short_preamble: use short preamble (CCK only)
1024 * @control.skip_table: skip externally configured rate table
1025 * @control.jiffies: timestamp for expiry on powersave clients
1026 * @control.vif: virtual interface (may be NULL)
1027 * @control.hw_key: key to encrypt with (may be NULL)
1028 * @control.flags: control flags, see &enum mac80211_tx_control_flags
1029 * @control.enqueue_time: enqueue time (for iTXQs)
1030 * @driver_rates: alias to @control.rates to reserve space
1031 * @pad: padding
1032 * @rate_driver_data: driver use area if driver needs @control.rates
1033 * @status: union part for status data
1034 * @status.rates: attempted rates
1035 * @status.ack_signal: ACK signal
1036 * @status.ampdu_ack_len: AMPDU ack length
1037 * @status.ampdu_len: AMPDU length
1038 * @status.antenna: (legacy, kept only for iwlegacy)
1039 * @status.tx_time: airtime consumed for transmission; note this is only
1040 * used for WMM AC, not for airtime fairness
1041 * @status.is_valid_ack_signal: ACK signal is valid
1042 * @status.status_driver_data: driver use area
1043 * @ack: union part for pure ACK data
1044 * @ack.cookie: cookie for the ACK
1045 * @driver_data: array of driver_data pointers
1046 * @ampdu_ack_len: number of acked aggregated frames.
1047 * relevant only if IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU was set.
1048 * @ampdu_len: number of aggregated frames.
1049 * relevant only if IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU was set.
1050 * @ack_signal: signal strength of the ACK frame
1051 */
1052 struct ieee80211_tx_info {
1053 /* common information */
1054 u32 flags;
1055 u32 band:3,
1056 ack_frame_id:13,
1057 hw_queue:4,
1058 tx_time_est:10;
1059 /* 2 free bits */
1060
1061 union {
1062 struct {
1063 union {
1064 /* rate control */
1065 struct {
1066 struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[
1067 IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1068 s8 rts_cts_rate_idx;
1069 u8 use_rts:1;
1070 u8 use_cts_prot:1;
1071 u8 short_preamble:1;
1072 u8 skip_table:1;
1073 /* 2 bytes free */
1074 };
1075 /* only needed before rate control */
1076 unsigned long jiffies;
1077 };
1078 /* NB: vif can be NULL for injected frames */
1079 struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
1080 struct ieee80211_key_conf *hw_key;
1081 u32 flags;
1082 codel_time_t enqueue_time;
1083 } control;
1084 struct {
1085 u64 cookie;
1086 } ack;
1087 struct {
1088 struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1089 s32 ack_signal;
1090 u8 ampdu_ack_len;
1091 u8 ampdu_len;
1092 u8 antenna;
1093 u16 tx_time;
1094 bool is_valid_ack_signal;
1095 void *status_driver_data[19 / sizeof(void *)];
1096 } status;
1097 struct {
1098 struct ieee80211_tx_rate driver_rates[
1099 IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1100 u8 pad[4];
1101
1102 void *rate_driver_data[
1103 IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)];
1104 };
1105 void *driver_data[
1106 IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)];
1107 };
1108 };
1109
1110 static inline u16
1111 ieee80211_info_set_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info, u16 tx_time_est)
1112 {
1113 /* We only have 10 bits in tx_time_est, so store airtime
1114 * in increments of 4us and clamp the maximum to 2**12-1
1115 */
1116 info->tx_time_est = min_t(u16, tx_time_est, 4095) >> 2;
1117 return info->tx_time_est << 2;
1118 }
1119
1120 static inline u16
1121 ieee80211_info_get_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
1122 {
1123 return info->tx_time_est << 2;
1124 }
1125
1126 /**
1127 * struct ieee80211_tx_status - extended tx status info for rate control
1128 *
1129 * @sta: Station that the packet was transmitted for
1130 * @info: Basic tx status information
1131 * @skb: Packet skb (can be NULL if not provided by the driver)
1132 * @rate: The TX rate that was used when sending the packet
1133 * @free_list: list where processed skbs are stored to be free'd by the driver
1134 */
1135 struct ieee80211_tx_status {
1136 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
1137 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info;
1138 struct sk_buff *skb;
1139 struct rate_info *rate;
1140 struct list_head *free_list;
1141 };
1142
1143 /**
1144 * struct ieee80211_scan_ies - descriptors for different blocks of IEs
1145 *
1146 * This structure is used to point to different blocks of IEs in HW scan
1147 * and scheduled scan. These blocks contain the IEs passed by userspace
1148 * and the ones generated by mac80211.
1149 *
1150 * @ies: pointers to band specific IEs.
1151 * @len: lengths of band_specific IEs.
1152 * @common_ies: IEs for all bands (especially vendor specific ones)
1153 * @common_ie_len: length of the common_ies
1154 */
1155 struct ieee80211_scan_ies {
1156 const u8 *ies[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
1157 size_t len[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
1158 const u8 *common_ies;
1159 size_t common_ie_len;
1160 };
1161
1162
1163 static inline struct ieee80211_tx_info *IEEE80211_SKB_CB(struct sk_buff *skb)
1164 {
1165 return (struct ieee80211_tx_info *)skb->cb;
1166 }
1167
1168 static inline struct ieee80211_rx_status *IEEE80211_SKB_RXCB(struct sk_buff *skb)
1169 {
1170 return (struct ieee80211_rx_status *)skb->cb;
1171 }
1172
1173 /**
1174 * ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status - clear TX status
1175 *
1176 * @info: The &struct ieee80211_tx_info to be cleared.
1177 *
1178 * When the driver passes an skb back to mac80211, it must report
1179 * a number of things in TX status. This function clears everything
1180 * in the TX status but the rate control information (it does clear
1181 * the count since you need to fill that in anyway).
1182 *
1183 * NOTE: You can only use this function if you do NOT use
1184 * info->driver_data! Use info->rate_driver_data
1185 * instead if you need only the less space that allows.
1186 */
1187 static inline void
1188 ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
1189 {
1190 int i;
1191
1192 BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) !=
1193 offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, control.rates));
1194 BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) !=
1195 offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, driver_rates));
1196 BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) != 8);
1197 /* clear the rate counts */
1198 for (i = 0; i < IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES; i++)
1199 info->status.rates[i].count = 0;
1200
1201 BUILD_BUG_ON(
1202 offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.ack_signal) != 20);
1203 memset(&info->status.ampdu_ack_len, 0,
1204 sizeof(struct ieee80211_tx_info) -
1205 offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.ampdu_ack_len));
1206 }
1207
1208
1209 /**
1210 * enum mac80211_rx_flags - receive flags
1211 *
1212 * These flags are used with the @flag member of &struct ieee80211_rx_status.
1213 * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR: Michael MIC error was reported on this frame.
1214 * Use together with %RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED.
1215 * @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED: This frame was decrypted in hardware.
1216 * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED: the Michael MIC is stripped off this frame,
1217 * verification has been done by the hardware.
1218 * @RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED: The IV and ICV are stripped from this frame.
1219 * If this flag is set, the stack cannot do any replay detection
1220 * hence the driver or hardware will have to do that.
1221 * @RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED: Currently only valid for CCMP/GCMP frames, this
1222 * flag indicates that the PN was verified for replay protection.
1223 * Note that this flag is also currently only supported when a frame
1224 * is also decrypted (ie. @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED must be set)
1225 * @RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED: The driver should set this flag if it did
1226 * de-duplication by itself.
1227 * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC: Set this flag if the FCS check failed on
1228 * the frame.
1229 * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC: Set this flag if the PCLP check failed on
1230 * the frame.
1231 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1232 * field) is valid and contains the time the first symbol of the MPDU
1233 * was received. This is useful in monitor mode and for proper IBSS
1234 * merging.
1235 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1236 * field) is valid and contains the time the last symbol of the MPDU
1237 * (including FCS) was received.
1238 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1239 * field) is valid and contains the time the SYNC preamble was received.
1240 * @RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL: The signal strength value is not present.
1241 * Valid only for data frames (mainly A-MPDU)
1242 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS: A-MPDU details are known, in particular the reference
1243 * number (@ampdu_reference) must be populated and be a distinct number for
1244 * each A-MPDU
1245 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN: last subframe is known, should be set on all
1246 * subframes of a single A-MPDU
1247 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST: this subframe is the last subframe of the A-MPDU
1248 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR: A delimiter CRC error has been detected
1249 * on this subframe
1250 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_KNOWN: The delimiter CRC field is known (the CRC
1251 * is stored in the @ampdu_delimiter_crc field)
1252 * @RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED: The mic was stripped of this packet. Decryption was
1253 * done by the hardware
1254 * @RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR: Report frame only to monitor interfaces without
1255 * processing it in any regular way.
1256 * This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report
1257 * them for sniffing purposes.
1258 * @RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR: Process and report frame to all interfaces except
1259 * monitor interfaces.
1260 * This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report
1261 * them for sniffing purposes.
1262 * @RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE: Some drivers may prefer to report separate A-MSDU
1263 * subframes instead of a one huge frame for performance reasons.
1264 * All, but the last MSDU from an A-MSDU should have this flag set. E.g.
1265 * if an A-MSDU has 3 frames, the first 2 must have the flag set, while
1266 * the 3rd (last) one must not have this flag set. The flag is used to
1267 * deal with retransmission/duplication recovery properly since A-MSDU
1268 * subframes share the same sequence number. Reported subframes can be
1269 * either regular MSDU or singly A-MSDUs. Subframes must not be
1270 * interleaved with other frames.
1271 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_VENDOR_DATA: This frame contains vendor-specific
1272 * radiotap data in the skb->data (before the frame) as described by
1273 * the &struct ieee80211_vendor_radiotap.
1274 * @RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN: Allow the same PN as same packet before.
1275 * This is used for AMSDU subframes which can have the same PN as
1276 * the first subframe.
1277 * @RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED: The ICV is stripped from this frame. CRC checking must
1278 * be done in the hardware.
1279 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT: Value of the EOF bit in the A-MPDU delimiter for this
1280 * frame
1281 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN: The EOF value is known
1282 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE: HE radiotap data is present
1283 * (&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he, mac80211 will fill in
1284 *
1285 * - DATA3_DATA_MCS
1286 * - DATA3_DATA_DCM
1287 * - DATA3_CODING
1288 * - DATA5_GI
1289 * - DATA5_DATA_BW_RU_ALLOC
1290 * - DATA6_NSTS
1291 * - DATA3_STBC
1292 *
1293 * from the RX info data, so leave those zeroed when building this data)
1294 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU: HE MU radiotap data is present
1295 * (&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he_mu)
1296 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG: L-SIG radiotap data is present
1297 * @RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU: use the frame only for radiotap reporting, with
1298 * the "0-length PSDU" field included there. The value for it is
1299 * in &struct ieee80211_rx_status. Note that if this value isn't
1300 * known the frame shouldn't be reported.
1301 * @RX_FLAG_8023: the frame has an 802.3 header (decap offload performed by
1302 * hardware or driver)
1303 */
1304 enum mac80211_rx_flags {
1305 RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR = BIT(0),
1306 RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED = BIT(1),
1307 RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START = BIT(2),
1308 RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED = BIT(3),
1309 RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED = BIT(4),
1310 RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC = BIT(5),
1311 RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC = BIT(6),
1312 RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START = BIT(7),
1313 RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL = BIT(8),
1314 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS = BIT(9),
1315 RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED = BIT(10),
1316 RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED = BIT(11),
1317 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN = BIT(12),
1318 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST = BIT(13),
1319 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR = BIT(14),
1320 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_KNOWN = BIT(15),
1321 RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END = BIT(16),
1322 RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR = BIT(17),
1323 RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR = BIT(18),
1324 RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE = BIT(19),
1325 RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_VENDOR_DATA = BIT(20),
1326 RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED = BIT(21),
1327 RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN = BIT(22),
1328 RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED = BIT(23),
1329 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT = BIT(24),
1330 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN = BIT(25),
1331 RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE = BIT(26),
1332 RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU = BIT(27),
1333 RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG = BIT(28),
1334 RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU = BIT(29),
1335 RX_FLAG_8023 = BIT(30),
1336 };
1337
1338 /**
1339 * enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags - MCS & bandwidth flags
1340 *
1341 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE: Short preamble was used for this frame
1342 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI: Short guard interval was used
1343 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF: This frame was received in a HT-greenfield transmission,
1344 * if the driver fills this value it should add
1345 * %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_FMT
1346 * to @hw.radiotap_mcs_details to advertise that fact.
1347 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC: LDPC was used
1348 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK: STBC 2 bit bitmask. 1 - Nss=1, 2 - Nss=2, 3 - Nss=3
1349 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_BF: packet was beamformed
1350 */
1351 enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags {
1352 RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE = BIT(0),
1353 RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI = BIT(2),
1354 RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF = BIT(3),
1355 RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK = BIT(4) | BIT(5),
1356 RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC = BIT(6),
1357 RX_ENC_FLAG_BF = BIT(7),
1358 };
1359
1360 #define RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_SHIFT 4
1361
1362 enum mac80211_rx_encoding {
1363 RX_ENC_LEGACY = 0,
1364 RX_ENC_HT,
1365 RX_ENC_VHT,
1366 RX_ENC_HE,
1367 };
1368
1369 /**
1370 * struct ieee80211_rx_status - receive status
1371 *
1372 * The low-level driver should provide this information (the subset
1373 * supported by hardware) to the 802.11 code with each received
1374 * frame, in the skb's control buffer (cb).
1375 *
1376 * @mactime: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization Function
1377 * (TSF) timer when the first data symbol (MPDU) arrived at the hardware.
1378 * @boottime_ns: CLOCK_BOOTTIME timestamp the frame was received at, this is
1379 * needed only for beacons and probe responses that update the scan cache.
1380 * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, mac80211 doesn't use
1381 * it but can store it and pass it back to the driver for synchronisation
1382 * @band: the active band when this frame was received
1383 * @freq: frequency the radio was tuned to when receiving this frame, in MHz
1384 * This field must be set for management frames, but isn't strictly needed
1385 * for data (other) frames - for those it only affects radiotap reporting.
1386 * @freq_offset: @freq has a positive offset of 500Khz.
1387 * @signal: signal strength when receiving this frame, either in dBm, in dB or
1388 * unspecified depending on the hardware capabilities flags
1389 * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_*
1390 * @chains: bitmask of receive chains for which separate signal strength
1391 * values were filled.
1392 * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength, in dBm (unlike @signal, doesn't
1393 * support dB or unspecified units)
1394 * @antenna: antenna used
1395 * @rate_idx: index of data rate into band's supported rates or MCS index if
1396 * HT or VHT is used (%RX_FLAG_HT/%RX_FLAG_VHT)
1397 * @nss: number of streams (VHT and HE only)
1398 * @flag: %RX_FLAG_\*
1399 * @encoding: &enum mac80211_rx_encoding
1400 * @bw: &enum rate_info_bw
1401 * @enc_flags: uses bits from &enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags
1402 * @he_ru: HE RU, from &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc
1403 * @he_gi: HE GI, from &enum nl80211_he_gi
1404 * @he_dcm: HE DCM value
1405 * @rx_flags: internal RX flags for mac80211
1406 * @ampdu_reference: A-MPDU reference number, must be a different value for
1407 * each A-MPDU but the same for each subframe within one A-MPDU
1408 * @ampdu_delimiter_crc: A-MPDU delimiter CRC
1409 * @zero_length_psdu_type: radiotap type of the 0-length PSDU
1410 */
1411 struct ieee80211_rx_status {
1412 u64 mactime;
1413 u64 boottime_ns;
1414 u32 device_timestamp;
1415 u32 ampdu_reference;
1416 u32 flag;
1417 u16 freq: 13, freq_offset: 1;
1418 u8 enc_flags;
1419 u8 encoding:2, bw:3, he_ru:3;
1420 u8 he_gi:2, he_dcm:1;
1421 u8 rate_idx;
1422 u8 nss;
1423 u8 rx_flags;
1424 u8 band;
1425 u8 antenna;
1426 s8 signal;
1427 u8 chains;
1428 s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
1429 u8 ampdu_delimiter_crc;
1430 u8 zero_length_psdu_type;
1431 };
1432
1433 static inline u32
1434 ieee80211_rx_status_to_khz(struct ieee80211_rx_status *rx_status)
1435 {
1436 return MHZ_TO_KHZ(rx_status->freq) +
1437 (rx_status->freq_offset ? 500 : 0);
1438 }
1439
1440 /**
1441 * struct ieee80211_vendor_radiotap - vendor radiotap data information
1442 * @present: presence bitmap for this vendor namespace
1443 * (this could be extended in the future if any vendor needs more
1444 * bits, the radiotap spec does allow for that)
1445 * @align: radiotap vendor namespace alignment. This defines the needed
1446 * alignment for the @data field below, not for the vendor namespace
1447 * description itself (which has a fixed 2-byte alignment)
1448 * Must be a power of two, and be set to at least 1!
1449 * @oui: radiotap vendor namespace OUI
1450 * @subns: radiotap vendor sub namespace
1451 * @len: radiotap vendor sub namespace skip length, if alignment is done
1452 * then that's added to this, i.e. this is only the length of the
1453 * @data field.
1454 * @pad: number of bytes of padding after the @data, this exists so that
1455 * the skb data alignment can be preserved even if the data has odd
1456 * length
1457 * @data: the actual vendor namespace data
1458 *
1459 * This struct, including the vendor data, goes into the skb->data before
1460 * the 802.11 header. It's split up in mac80211 using the align/oui/subns
1461 * data.
1462 */
1463 struct ieee80211_vendor_radiotap {
1464 u32 present;
1465 u8 align;
1466 u8 oui[3];
1467 u8 subns;
1468 u8 pad;
1469 u16 len;
1470 u8 data[];
1471 } __packed;
1472
1473 /**
1474 * enum ieee80211_conf_flags - configuration flags
1475 *
1476 * Flags to define PHY configuration options
1477 *
1478 * @IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR: there's a monitor interface present -- use this
1479 * to determine for example whether to calculate timestamps for packets
1480 * or not, do not use instead of filter flags!
1481 * @IEEE80211_CONF_PS: Enable 802.11 power save mode (managed mode only).
1482 * This is the power save mode defined by IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2,
1483 * meaning that the hardware still wakes up for beacons, is able to
1484 * transmit frames and receive the possible acknowledgment frames.
1485 * Not to be confused with hardware specific wakeup/sleep states,
1486 * driver is responsible for that. See the section "Powersave support"
1487 * for more.
1488 * @IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE: The device is running, but idle; if the flag is set
1489 * the driver should be prepared to handle configuration requests but
1490 * may turn the device off as much as possible. Typically, this flag will
1491 * be set when an interface is set UP but not associated or scanning, but
1492 * it can also be unset in that case when monitor interfaces are active.
1493 * @IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL: The device is currently not on its main
1494 * operating channel.
1495 */
1496 enum ieee80211_conf_flags {
1497 IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR = (1<<0),
1498 IEEE80211_CONF_PS = (1<<1),
1499 IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE = (1<<2),
1500 IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL = (1<<3),
1501 };
1502
1503
1504 /**
1505 * enum ieee80211_conf_changed - denotes which configuration changed
1506 *
1507 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL: the listen interval changed
1508 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR: the monitor flag changed
1509 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS: the PS flag or dynamic PS timeout changed
1510 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER: the TX power changed
1511 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL: the channel/channel_type changed
1512 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS: retry limits changed
1513 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE: Idle flag changed
1514 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS: Spatial multiplexing powersave mode changed
1515 * Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used,
1516 * otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed.
1517 */
1518 enum ieee80211_conf_changed {
1519 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS = BIT(1),
1520 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL = BIT(2),
1521 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR = BIT(3),
1522 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS = BIT(4),
1523 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER = BIT(5),
1524 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL = BIT(6),
1525 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS = BIT(7),
1526 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE = BIT(8),
1527 };
1528
1529 /**
1530 * enum ieee80211_smps_mode - spatial multiplexing power save mode
1531 *
1532 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC: automatic
1533 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF: off
1534 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC: static
1535 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC: dynamic
1536 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES: internal, don't use
1537 */
1538 enum ieee80211_smps_mode {
1539 IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC,
1540 IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF,
1541 IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC,
1542 IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC,
1543
1544 /* keep last */
1545 IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES,
1546 };
1547
1548 /**
1549 * struct ieee80211_conf - configuration of the device
1550 *
1551 * This struct indicates how the driver shall configure the hardware.
1552 *
1553 * @flags: configuration flags defined above
1554 *
1555 * @listen_interval: listen interval in units of beacon interval
1556 * @ps_dtim_period: The DTIM period of the AP we're connected to, for use
1557 * in power saving. Power saving will not be enabled until a beacon
1558 * has been received and the DTIM period is known.
1559 * @dynamic_ps_timeout: The dynamic powersave timeout (in ms), see the
1560 * powersave documentation below. This variable is valid only when
1561 * the CONF_PS flag is set.
1562 *
1563 * @power_level: requested transmit power (in dBm), backward compatibility
1564 * value only that is set to the minimum of all interfaces
1565 *
1566 * @chandef: the channel definition to tune to
1567 * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled
1568 *
1569 * @long_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "long" frame
1570 * (a frame not RTS protected), called "dot11LongRetryLimit" in 802.11,
1571 * but actually means the number of transmissions not the number of retries
1572 * @short_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "short"
1573 * frame, called "dot11ShortRetryLimit" in 802.11, but actually means the
1574 * number of transmissions not the number of retries
1575 *
1576 * @smps_mode: spatial multiplexing powersave mode; note that
1577 * %IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC is used when the device is not
1578 * configured for an HT channel.
1579 * Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used,
1580 * otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed.
1581 */
1582 struct ieee80211_conf {
1583 u32 flags;
1584 int power_level, dynamic_ps_timeout;
1585
1586 u16 listen_interval;
1587 u8 ps_dtim_period;
1588
1589 u8 long_frame_max_tx_count, short_frame_max_tx_count;
1590
1591 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1592 bool radar_enabled;
1593 enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
1594 };
1595
1596 /**
1597 * struct ieee80211_channel_switch - holds the channel switch data
1598 *
1599 * The information provided in this structure is required for channel switch
1600 * operation.
1601 *
1602 * @timestamp: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization
1603 * Function (TSF) timer when the frame containing the channel switch
1604 * announcement was received. This is simply the rx.mactime parameter
1605 * the driver passed into mac80211.
1606 * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, this is the
1607 * rx.device_timestamp parameter the driver passed to mac80211.
1608 * @block_tx: Indicates whether transmission must be blocked before the
1609 * scheduled channel switch, as indicated by the AP.
1610 * @chandef: the new channel to switch to
1611 * @count: the number of TBTT's until the channel switch event
1612 * @delay: maximum delay between the time the AP transmitted the last beacon in
1613 * current channel and the expected time of the first beacon in the new
1614 * channel, expressed in TU.
1615 */
1616 struct ieee80211_channel_switch {
1617 u64 timestamp;
1618 u32 device_timestamp;
1619 bool block_tx;
1620 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1621 u8 count;
1622 u32 delay;
1623 };
1624
1625 /**
1626 * enum ieee80211_vif_flags - virtual interface flags
1627 *
1628 * @IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER: the device performs beacon filtering
1629 * on this virtual interface to avoid unnecessary CPU wakeups
1630 * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI: the device can do connection quality
1631 * monitoring on this virtual interface -- i.e. it can monitor
1632 * connection quality related parameters, such as the RSSI level and
1633 * provide notifications if configured trigger levels are reached.
1634 * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD: The device can do U-APSD for this
1635 * interface. This flag should be set during interface addition,
1636 * but may be set/cleared as late as authentication to an AP. It is
1637 * only valid for managed/station mode interfaces.
1638 * @IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE: request to handle NOA attributes
1639 * and send P2P_PS notification to the driver if NOA changed, even
1640 * this is not pure P2P vif.
1641 */
1642 enum ieee80211_vif_flags {
1643 IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER = BIT(0),
1644 IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI = BIT(1),
1645 IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD = BIT(2),
1646 IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE = BIT(3),
1647 };
1648
1649
1650 /**
1651 * enum ieee80211_offload_flags - virtual interface offload flags
1652 *
1653 * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_ENABLED: tx encapsulation offload is enabled
1654 * The driver supports sending frames passed as 802.3 frames by mac80211.
1655 * It must also support sending 802.11 packets for the same interface.
1656 * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_4ADDR: support 4-address mode encapsulation offload
1657 * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_DECAP_ENABLED: rx encapsulation offload is enabled
1658 * The driver supports passing received 802.11 frames as 802.3 frames to
1659 * mac80211.
1660 */
1661
1662 enum ieee80211_offload_flags {
1663 IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_ENABLED = BIT(0),
1664 IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_4ADDR = BIT(1),
1665 IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_DECAP_ENABLED = BIT(2),
1666 };
1667
1668 /**
1669 * struct ieee80211_vif - per-interface data
1670 *
1671 * Data in this structure is continually present for driver
1672 * use during the life of a virtual interface.
1673 *
1674 * @type: type of this virtual interface
1675 * @bss_conf: BSS configuration for this interface, either our own
1676 * or the BSS we're associated to
1677 * @addr: address of this interface
1678 * @p2p: indicates whether this AP or STA interface is a p2p
1679 * interface, i.e. a GO or p2p-sta respectively
1680 * @csa_active: marks whether a channel switch is going on. Internally it is
1681 * write-protected by sdata_lock and local->mtx so holding either is fine
1682 * for read access.
1683 * @mu_mimo_owner: indicates interface owns MU-MIMO capability
1684 * @driver_flags: flags/capabilities the driver has for this interface,
1685 * these need to be set (or cleared) when the interface is added
1686 * or, if supported by the driver, the interface type is changed
1687 * at runtime, mac80211 will never touch this field
1688 * @offloaad_flags: hardware offload capabilities/flags for this interface.
1689 * These are initialized by mac80211 before calling .add_interface,
1690 * .change_interface or .update_vif_offload and updated by the driver
1691 * within these ops, based on supported features or runtime change
1692 * restrictions.
1693 * @hw_queue: hardware queue for each AC
1694 * @cab_queue: content-after-beacon (DTIM beacon really) queue, AP mode only
1695 * @chanctx_conf: The channel context this interface is assigned to, or %NULL
1696 * when it is not assigned. This pointer is RCU-protected due to the TX
1697 * path needing to access it; even though the netdev carrier will always
1698 * be off when it is %NULL there can still be races and packets could be
1699 * processed after it switches back to %NULL.
1700 * @debugfs_dir: debugfs dentry, can be used by drivers to create own per
1701 * interface debug files. Note that it will be NULL for the virtual
1702 * monitor interface (if that is requested.)
1703 * @probe_req_reg: probe requests should be reported to mac80211 for this
1704 * interface.
1705 * @rx_mcast_action_reg: multicast Action frames should be reported to mac80211
1706 * for this interface.
1707 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
1708 * sizeof(void \*).
1709 * @txq: the multicast data TX queue (if driver uses the TXQ abstraction)
1710 * @txqs_stopped: per AC flag to indicate that intermediate TXQs are stopped,
1711 * protected by fq->lock.
1712 * @offload_flags: 802.3 -> 802.11 enapsulation offload flags, see
1713 * &enum ieee80211_offload_flags.
1714 */
1715 struct ieee80211_vif {
1716 enum nl80211_iftype type;
1717 struct ieee80211_bss_conf bss_conf;
1718 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
1719 bool p2p;
1720 bool csa_active;
1721 bool mu_mimo_owner;
1722
1723 u8 cab_queue;
1724 u8 hw_queue[IEEE80211_NUM_ACS];
1725
1726 struct ieee80211_txq *txq;
1727
1728 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf __rcu *chanctx_conf;
1729
1730 u32 driver_flags;
1731 u32 offload_flags;
1732
1733 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS
1734 struct dentry *debugfs_dir;
1735 #endif
1736
1737 bool probe_req_reg;
1738 bool rx_mcast_action_reg;
1739
1740 bool txqs_stopped[IEEE80211_NUM_ACS];
1741
1742 /* must be last */
1743 u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
1744 };
1745
1746 static inline bool ieee80211_vif_is_mesh(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
1747 {
1748 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_MESH
1749 return vif->type == NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT;
1750 #endif
1751 return false;
1752 }
1753
1754 /**
1755 * wdev_to_ieee80211_vif - return a vif struct from a wdev
1756 * @wdev: the wdev to get the vif for
1757 *
1758 * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs
1759 * (like the vendor commands) that get a wdev.
1760 *
1761 * Note that this function may return %NULL if the given wdev isn't
1762 * associated with a vif that the driver knows about (e.g. monitor
1763 * or AP_VLAN interfaces.)
1764 */
1765 struct ieee80211_vif *wdev_to_ieee80211_vif(struct wireless_dev *wdev);
1766
1767 /**
1768 * ieee80211_vif_to_wdev - return a wdev struct from a vif
1769 * @vif: the vif to get the wdev for
1770 *
1771 * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs
1772 * (like the vendor commands) that needs to get the wdev for a vif.
1773 * This can also be useful to get the netdev associated to a vif.
1774 */
1775 struct wireless_dev *ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
1776
1777 /**
1778 * enum ieee80211_key_flags - key flags
1779 *
1780 * These flags are used for communication about keys between the driver
1781 * and mac80211, with the @flags parameter of &struct ieee80211_key_conf.
1782 *
1783 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV: This flag should be set by the
1784 * driver to indicate that it requires IV generation for this
1785 * particular key. Setting this flag does not necessarily mean that SKBs
1786 * will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or MIC.
1787 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC: This flag should be set by
1788 * the driver for a TKIP key if it requires Michael MIC
1789 * generation in software.
1790 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE: Set by mac80211, this flag indicates
1791 * that the key is pairwise rather then a shared key.
1792 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX: This flag should be set by the driver for a
1793 * CCMP/GCMP key if it requires CCMP/GCMP encryption of management frames
1794 * (MFP) to be done in software.
1795 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver
1796 * if space should be prepared for the IV, but the IV
1797 * itself should not be generated. Do not set together with
1798 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV on the same key. Setting this flag does
1799 * not necessarily mean that SKBs will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or
1800 * MIC.
1801 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT: This key will be used to decrypt received
1802 * management frames. The flag can help drivers that have a hardware
1803 * crypto implementation that doesn't deal with management frames
1804 * properly by allowing them to not upload the keys to hardware and
1805 * fall back to software crypto. Note that this flag deals only with
1806 * RX, if your crypto engine can't deal with TX you can also set the
1807 * %IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX flag to encrypt such frames in SW.
1808 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT: This flag should be set by the
1809 * driver for a CCMP/GCMP key to indicate that is requires IV generation
1810 * only for management frames (MFP).
1811 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM: This flag should be set by the
1812 * driver for a key to indicate that sufficient tailroom must always
1813 * be reserved for ICV or MIC, even when HW encryption is enabled.
1814 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver for
1815 * a TKIP key if it only requires MIC space. Do not set together with
1816 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC on the same key.
1817 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX: Key needs explicit Tx activation.
1818 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE: This flag should be set by the driver
1819 * for a AES_CMAC key to indicate that it requires sequence number
1820 * generation only
1821 */
1822 enum ieee80211_key_flags {
1823 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT = BIT(0),
1824 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV = BIT(1),
1825 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC = BIT(2),
1826 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE = BIT(3),
1827 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX = BIT(4),
1828 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE = BIT(5),
1829 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT = BIT(6),
1830 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM = BIT(7),
1831 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE = BIT(8),
1832 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX = BIT(9),
1833 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE = BIT(10),
1834 };
1835
1836 /**
1837 * struct ieee80211_key_conf - key information
1838 *
1839 * This key information is given by mac80211 to the driver by
1840 * the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops.
1841 *
1842 * @hw_key_idx: To be set by the driver, this is the key index the driver
1843 * wants to be given when a frame is transmitted and needs to be
1844 * encrypted in hardware.
1845 * @cipher: The key's cipher suite selector.
1846 * @tx_pn: PN used for TX keys, may be used by the driver as well if it
1847 * needs to do software PN assignment by itself (e.g. due to TSO)
1848 * @flags: key flags, see &enum ieee80211_key_flags.
1849 * @keyidx: the key index (0-3)
1850 * @keylen: key material length
1851 * @key: key material. For ALG_TKIP the key is encoded as a 256-bit (32 byte)
1852 * data block:
1853 * - Temporal Encryption Key (128 bits)
1854 * - Temporal Authenticator Tx MIC Key (64 bits)
1855 * - Temporal Authenticator Rx MIC Key (64 bits)
1856 * @icv_len: The ICV length for this key type
1857 * @iv_len: The IV length for this key type
1858 */
1859 struct ieee80211_key_conf {
1860 atomic64_t tx_pn;
1861 u32 cipher;
1862 u8 icv_len;
1863 u8 iv_len;
1864 u8 hw_key_idx;
1865 s8 keyidx;
1866 u16 flags;
1867 u8 keylen;
1868 u8 key[];
1869 };
1870
1871 #define IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN 16
1872
1873 #define TKIP_PN_TO_IV16(pn) ((u16)(pn & 0xffff))
1874 #define TKIP_PN_TO_IV32(pn) ((u32)((pn >> 16) & 0xffffffff))
1875
1876 /**
1877 * struct ieee80211_key_seq - key sequence counter
1878 *
1879 * @tkip: TKIP data, containing IV32 and IV16 in host byte order
1880 * @ccmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
1881 * reverse order than in packet)
1882 * @aes_cmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
1883 * reverse order than in packet)
1884 * @aes_gmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
1885 * reverse order than in packet)
1886 * @gcmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
1887 * reverse order than in packet)
1888 * @hw: data for HW-only (e.g. cipher scheme) keys
1889 */
1890 struct ieee80211_key_seq {
1891 union {
1892 struct {
1893 u32 iv32;
1894 u16 iv16;
1895 } tkip;
1896 struct {
1897 u8 pn[6];
1898 } ccmp;
1899 struct {
1900 u8 pn[6];
1901 } aes_cmac;
1902 struct {
1903 u8 pn[6];
1904 } aes_gmac;
1905 struct {
1906 u8 pn[6];
1907 } gcmp;
1908 struct {
1909 u8 seq[IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN];
1910 u8 seq_len;
1911 } hw;
1912 };
1913 };
1914
1915 /**
1916 * struct ieee80211_cipher_scheme - cipher scheme
1917 *
1918 * This structure contains a cipher scheme information defining
1919 * the secure packet crypto handling.
1920 *
1921 * @cipher: a cipher suite selector
1922 * @iftype: a cipher iftype bit mask indicating an allowed cipher usage
1923 * @hdr_len: a length of a security header used the cipher
1924 * @pn_len: a length of a packet number in the security header
1925 * @pn_off: an offset of pn from the beginning of the security header
1926 * @key_idx_off: an offset of key index byte in the security header
1927 * @key_idx_mask: a bit mask of key_idx bits
1928 * @key_idx_shift: a bit shift needed to get key_idx
1929 * key_idx value calculation:
1930 * (sec_header_base[key_idx_off] & key_idx_mask) >> key_idx_shift
1931 * @mic_len: a mic length in bytes
1932 */
1933 struct ieee80211_cipher_scheme {
1934 u32 cipher;
1935 u16 iftype;
1936 u8 hdr_len;
1937 u8 pn_len;
1938 u8 pn_off;
1939 u8 key_idx_off;
1940 u8 key_idx_mask;
1941 u8 key_idx_shift;
1942 u8 mic_len;
1943 };
1944
1945 /**
1946 * enum set_key_cmd - key command
1947 *
1948 * Used with the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this
1949 * indicates whether a key is being removed or added.
1950 *
1951 * @SET_KEY: a key is set
1952 * @DISABLE_KEY: a key must be disabled
1953 */
1954 enum set_key_cmd {
1955 SET_KEY, DISABLE_KEY,
1956 };
1957
1958 /**
1959 * enum ieee80211_sta_state - station state
1960 *
1961 * @IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST: station doesn't exist at all,
1962 * this is a special state for add/remove transitions
1963 * @IEEE80211_STA_NONE: station exists without special state
1964 * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTH: station is authenticated
1965 * @IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC: station is associated
1966 * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED: station is authorized (802.1X)
1967 */
1968 enum ieee80211_sta_state {
1969 /* NOTE: These need to be ordered correctly! */
1970 IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST,
1971 IEEE80211_STA_NONE,
1972 IEEE80211_STA_AUTH,
1973 IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC,
1974 IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED,
1975 };
1976
1977 /**
1978 * enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth - station RX bandwidth
1979 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20: station can only receive 20 MHz
1980 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40: station can receive up to 40 MHz
1981 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80: station can receive up to 80 MHz
1982 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160: station can receive up to 160 MHz
1983 * (including 80+80 MHz)
1984 *
1985 * Implementation note: 20 must be zero to be initialized
1986 * correctly, the values must be sorted.
1987 */
1988 enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth {
1989 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20 = 0,
1990 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40,
1991 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80,
1992 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160,
1993 };
1994
1995 /**
1996 * struct ieee80211_sta_rates - station rate selection table
1997 *
1998 * @rcu_head: RCU head used for freeing the table on update
1999 * @rate: transmit rates/flags to be used by default.
2000 * Overriding entries per-packet is possible by using cb tx control.
2001 */
2002 struct ieee80211_sta_rates {
2003 struct rcu_head rcu_head;
2004 struct {
2005 s8 idx;
2006 u8 count;
2007 u8 count_cts;
2008 u8 count_rts;
2009 u16 flags;
2010 } rate[IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE];
2011 };
2012
2013 /**
2014 * struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr - station txpower configuration
2015 *
2016 * Used to configure txpower for station.
2017 *
2018 * @power: indicates the tx power, in dBm, to be used when sending data frames
2019 * to the STA.
2020 * @type: In particular if TPC %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED then tx power
2021 * will be less than or equal to specified from userspace, whereas if TPC
2022 * %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC then it indicates default tx power.
2023 * NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED is not a valid configuration option for
2024 * per peer TPC.
2025 */
2026 struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr {
2027 s16 power;
2028 enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type;
2029 };
2030
2031 /**
2032 * struct ieee80211_sta - station table entry
2033 *
2034 * A station table entry represents a station we are possibly
2035 * communicating with. Since stations are RCU-managed in
2036 * mac80211, any ieee80211_sta pointer you get access to must
2037 * either be protected by rcu_read_lock() explicitly or implicitly,
2038 * or you must take good care to not use such a pointer after a
2039 * call to your sta_remove callback that removed it.
2040 *
2041 * @addr: MAC address
2042 * @aid: AID we assigned to the station if we're an AP
2043 * @supp_rates: Bitmap of supported rates (per band)
2044 * @ht_cap: HT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities
2045 * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities
2046 * @he_cap: HE capabilities of this STA
2047 * @he_6ghz_capa: on 6 GHz, holds the HE 6 GHz band capabilities
2048 * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximal amount of frames in a single AMPDU
2049 * that this station is allowed to transmit to us.
2050 * Can be modified by driver.
2051 * @wme: indicates whether the STA supports QoS/WME (if local devices does,
2052 * otherwise always false)
2053 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
2054 * sizeof(void \*), size is determined in hw information.
2055 * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. Only valid
2056 * if wme is supported. The bits order is like in
2057 * IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_*.
2058 * @max_sp: max Service Period. Only valid if wme is supported.
2059 * @bandwidth: current bandwidth the station can receive with
2060 * @rx_nss: in HT/VHT, the maximum number of spatial streams the
2061 * station can receive at the moment, changed by operating mode
2062 * notifications and capabilities. The value is only valid after
2063 * the station moves to associated state.
2064 * @smps_mode: current SMPS mode (off, static or dynamic)
2065 * @rates: rate control selection table
2066 * @tdls: indicates whether the STA is a TDLS peer
2067 * @tdls_initiator: indicates the STA is an initiator of the TDLS link. Only
2068 * valid if the STA is a TDLS peer in the first place.
2069 * @mfp: indicates whether the STA uses management frame protection or not.
2070 * @max_amsdu_subframes: indicates the maximal number of MSDUs in a single
2071 * A-MSDU. Taken from the Extended Capabilities element. 0 means
2072 * unlimited.
2073 * @support_p2p_ps: indicates whether the STA supports P2P PS mechanism or not.
2074 * @max_rc_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes recommended by rate control.
2075 * @max_tid_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes for this TID
2076 * @txpwr: the station tx power configuration
2077 * @txq: per-TID data TX queues (if driver uses the TXQ abstraction); note that
2078 * the last entry (%IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS) is used for non-data frames
2079 */
2080 struct ieee80211_sta {
2081 u32 supp_rates[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2082 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
2083 u16 aid;
2084 struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap ht_cap;
2085 struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap vht_cap;
2086 struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap he_cap;
2087 struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa he_6ghz_capa;
2088 u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes;
2089 bool wme;
2090 u8 uapsd_queues;
2091 u8 max_sp;
2092 u8 rx_nss;
2093 enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth bandwidth;
2094 enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
2095 struct ieee80211_sta_rates __rcu *rates;
2096 bool tdls;
2097 bool tdls_initiator;
2098 bool mfp;
2099 u8 max_amsdu_subframes;
2100
2101 /**
2102 * @max_amsdu_len:
2103 * indicates the maximal length of an A-MSDU in bytes.
2104 * This field is always valid for packets with a VHT preamble.
2105 * For packets with a HT preamble, additional limits apply:
2106 *
2107 * * If the skb is transmitted as part of a BA agreement, the
2108 * A-MSDU maximal size is min(max_amsdu_len, 4065) bytes.
2109 * * If the skb is not part of a BA agreement, the A-MSDU maximal
2110 * size is min(max_amsdu_len, 7935) bytes.
2111 *
2112 * Both additional HT limits must be enforced by the low level
2113 * driver. This is defined by the spec (IEEE 802.11-2012 section
2114 * 8.3.2.2 NOTE 2).
2115 */
2116 u16 max_amsdu_len;
2117 bool support_p2p_ps;
2118 u16 max_rc_amsdu_len;
2119 u16 max_tid_amsdu_len[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS];
2120 struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr txpwr;
2121
2122 struct ieee80211_txq *txq[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS + 1];
2123
2124 /* must be last */
2125 u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2126 };
2127
2128 /**
2129 * enum sta_notify_cmd - sta notify command
2130 *
2131 * Used with the sta_notify() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this
2132 * indicates if an associated station made a power state transition.
2133 *
2134 * @STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP: a station is now sleeping
2135 * @STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE: a sleeping station woke up
2136 */
2137 enum sta_notify_cmd {
2138 STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP, STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE,
2139 };
2140
2141 /**
2142 * struct ieee80211_tx_control - TX control data
2143 *
2144 * @sta: station table entry, this sta pointer may be NULL and
2145 * it is not allowed to copy the pointer, due to RCU.
2146 */
2147 struct ieee80211_tx_control {
2148 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2149 };
2150
2151 /**
2152 * struct ieee80211_txq - Software intermediate tx queue
2153 *
2154 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
2155 * @sta: station table entry, %NULL for per-vif queue
2156 * @tid: the TID for this queue (unused for per-vif queue),
2157 * %IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS for non-data (if enabled)
2158 * @ac: the AC for this queue
2159 * @drv_priv: driver private area, sized by hw->txq_data_size
2160 *
2161 * The driver can obtain packets from this queue by calling
2162 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue().
2163 */
2164 struct ieee80211_txq {
2165 struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
2166 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2167 u8 tid;
2168 u8 ac;
2169
2170 /* must be last */
2171 u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2172 };
2173
2174 /**
2175 * enum ieee80211_hw_flags - hardware flags
2176 *
2177 * These flags are used to indicate hardware capabilities to
2178 * the stack. Generally, flags here should have their meaning
2179 * done in a way that the simplest hardware doesn't need setting
2180 * any particular flags. There are some exceptions to this rule,
2181 * however, so you are advised to review these flags carefully.
2182 *
2183 * @IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL:
2184 * The hardware or firmware includes rate control, and cannot be
2185 * controlled by the stack. As such, no rate control algorithm
2186 * should be instantiated, and the TX rate reported to userspace
2187 * will be taken from the TX status instead of the rate control
2188 * algorithm.
2189 * Note that this requires that the driver implement a number of
2190 * callbacks so it has the correct information, it needs to have
2191 * the @set_rts_threshold callback and must look at the BSS config
2192 * @use_cts_prot for G/N protection, @use_short_slot for slot
2193 * timing in 2.4 GHz and @use_short_preamble for preambles for
2194 * CCK frames.
2195 *
2196 * @IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS:
2197 * Indicates that received frames passed to the stack include
2198 * the FCS at the end.
2199 *
2200 * @IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING:
2201 * Some wireless LAN chipsets buffer broadcast/multicast frames
2202 * for power saving stations in the hardware/firmware and others
2203 * rely on the host system for such buffering. This option is used
2204 * to configure the IEEE 802.11 upper layer to buffer broadcast and
2205 * multicast frames when there are power saving stations so that
2206 * the driver can fetch them with ieee80211_get_buffered_bc().
2207 *
2208 * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC:
2209 * Hardware can provide signal values but we don't know its units. We
2210 * expect values between 0 and @max_signal.
2211 * If possible please provide dB or dBm instead.
2212 *
2213 * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM:
2214 * Hardware gives signal values in dBm, decibel difference from
2215 * one milliwatt. This is the preferred method since it is standardized
2216 * between different devices. @max_signal does not need to be set.
2217 *
2218 * @IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT:
2219 * Hardware supports spectrum management defined in 802.11h
2220 * Measurement, Channel Switch, Quieting, TPC
2221 *
2222 * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION:
2223 * Hardware supports 11n A-MPDU aggregation.
2224 *
2225 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS:
2226 * Hardware has power save support (i.e. can go to sleep).
2227 *
2228 * @IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK:
2229 * Hardware requires nullfunc frame handling in stack, implies
2230 * stack support for dynamic PS.
2231 *
2232 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS:
2233 * Hardware has support for dynamic PS.
2234 *
2235 * @IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE:
2236 * Hardware supports management frame protection (MFP, IEEE 802.11w).
2237 *
2238 * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS:
2239 * Hardware can provide ack status reports of Tx frames to
2240 * the stack.
2241 *
2242 * @IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR:
2243 * The hardware performs its own connection monitoring, including
2244 * periodic keep-alives to the AP and probing the AP on beacon loss.
2245 *
2246 * @IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC:
2247 * This device needs to get data from beacon before association (i.e.
2248 * dtim_period).
2249 *
2250 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK: The device's crypto engine supports
2251 * per-station GTKs as used by IBSS RSN or during fast transition. If
2252 * the device doesn't support per-station GTKs, but can be asked not
2253 * to decrypt group addressed frames, then IBSS RSN support is still
2254 * possible but software crypto will be used. Advertise the wiphy flag
2255 * only in that case.
2256 *
2257 * @IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS: When operating in AP mode the device
2258 * autonomously manages the PS status of connected stations. When
2259 * this flag is set mac80211 will not trigger PS mode for connected
2260 * stations based on the PM bit of incoming frames.
2261 * Use ieee80211_start_ps()/ieee8021_end_ps() to manually configure
2262 * the PS mode of connected stations.
2263 *
2264 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW: The device handles TX A-MPDU session
2265 * setup strictly in HW. mac80211 should not attempt to do this in
2266 * software.
2267 *
2268 * @IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF: The driver would like to be informed of
2269 * a virtual monitor interface when monitor interfaces are the only
2270 * active interfaces.
2271 *
2272 * @IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF: The driver would like for no wlanX to
2273 * be created. It is expected user-space will create vifs as
2274 * desired (and thus have them named as desired).
2275 *
2276 * @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL: The driver wants to control which of the
2277 * crypto algorithms can be done in software - so don't automatically
2278 * try to fall back to it if hardware crypto fails, but do so only if
2279 * the driver returns 1. This also forces the driver to advertise its
2280 * supported cipher suites.
2281 *
2282 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT: The driver/hardware supports fast-xmit,
2283 * this currently requires only the ability to calculate the duration
2284 * for frames.
2285 *
2286 * @IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL: The driver wants to control per-interface
2287 * queue mapping in order to use different queues (not just one per AC)
2288 * for different virtual interfaces. See the doc section on HW queue
2289 * control for more details.
2290 *
2291 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE: The driver supports using a rate
2292 * selection table provided by the rate control algorithm.
2293 *
2294 * @IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF: Use the P2P Device address for any
2295 * P2P Interface. This will be honoured even if more than one interface
2296 * is supported.
2297 *
2298 * @IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY: Use sync timing from beacon frames
2299 * only, to allow getting TBTT of a DTIM beacon.
2300 *
2301 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES: Hardware supports mixing HT/CCK rates
2302 * and can cope with CCK rates in an aggregation session (e.g. by not
2303 * using aggregation for such frames.)
2304 *
2305 * @IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA: Support 802.11h based channel-switch (CSA)
2306 * for a single active channel while using channel contexts. When support
2307 * is not enabled the default action is to disconnect when getting the
2308 * CSA frame.
2309 *
2310 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS: The driver will never modify the payload
2311 * or tailroom of TX skbs without copying them first.
2312 *
2313 * @IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS: The HW supports scanning on all bands
2314 * in one command, mac80211 doesn't have to run separate scans per band.
2315 *
2316 * @IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW: The device/driver supports wider bandwidth
2317 * than then BSS bandwidth for a TDLS link on the base channel.
2318 *
2319 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU: The driver supports receiving A-MSDUs
2320 * within A-MPDU.
2321 *
2322 * @IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS: The device/driver provides TX status
2323 * for sent beacons.
2324 *
2325 * @IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR: Hardware (or driver) requires that each
2326 * station has a unique address, i.e. each station entry can be identified
2327 * by just its MAC address; this prevents, for example, the same station
2328 * from connecting to two virtual AP interfaces at the same time.
2329 *
2330 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER: Hardware (or driver) manages the
2331 * reordering buffer internally, guaranteeing mac80211 receives frames in
2332 * order and does not need to manage its own reorder buffer or BA session
2333 * timeout.
2334 *
2335 * @IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS: The device uses RSS and thus requires parallel RX,
2336 * which implies using per-CPU station statistics.
2337 *
2338 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU: Hardware (or driver) supports software aggregated
2339 * A-MSDU frames. Requires software tx queueing and fast-xmit support.
2340 * When not using minstrel/minstrel_ht rate control, the driver must
2341 * limit the maximum A-MSDU size based on the current tx rate by setting
2342 * max_rc_amsdu_len in struct ieee80211_sta.
2343 *
2344 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST: Hardware (or driver) supports sending frag_list
2345 * skbs, needed for zero-copy software A-MSDU.
2346 *
2347 * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK: The driver (or firmware) reports low ack event
2348 * by ieee80211_report_low_ack() based on its own algorithm. For such
2349 * drivers, mac80211 packet loss mechanism will not be triggered and driver
2350 * is completely depending on firmware event for station kickout.
2351 *
2352 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG: Hardware does fragmentation by itself.
2353 * The stack will not do fragmentation.
2354 * The callback for @set_frag_threshold should be set as well.
2355 *
2356 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA: Hardware supports buffer STA on
2357 * TDLS links.
2358 *
2359 * @IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP: The driver requires the
2360 * mgd_prepare_tx() callback to be called before transmission of a
2361 * deauthentication frame in case the association was completed but no
2362 * beacon was heard. This is required in multi-channel scenarios, where the
2363 * virtual interface might not be given air time for the transmission of
2364 * the frame, as it is not synced with the AP/P2P GO yet, and thus the
2365 * deauthentication frame might not be transmitted.
2366 *
2367 * @IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP: The driver (or firmware) doesn't
2368 * support QoS NDP for AP probing - that's most likely a driver bug.
2369 *
2370 * @IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ: use the TXQ for bufferable MMPDUs, this of
2371 * course requires the driver to use TXQs to start with.
2372 *
2373 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW: (Hardware) rate control supports VHT
2374 * extended NSS BW (dot11VHTExtendedNSSBWCapable). This flag will be set if
2375 * the selected rate control algorithm sets %RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW
2376 * but if the rate control is built-in then it must be set by the driver.
2377 * See also the documentation for that flag.
2378 *
2379 * @IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ: use the extra non-TID per-station TXQ for all
2380 * MMPDUs on station interfaces. This of course requires the driver to use
2381 * TXQs to start with.
2382 *
2383 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN: Driver does not report accurate A-MPDU
2384 * length in tx status information
2385 *
2386 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID
2387 *
2388 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID
2389 * only for HE APs. Applies if @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID is set.
2390 *
2391 * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT: The card and driver is only
2392 * aggregating MPDUs with the same keyid, allowing mac80211 to keep Tx
2393 * A-MPDU sessions active while rekeying with Extended Key ID.
2394 *
2395 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_ENCAP_OFFLOAD: Hardware supports tx encapsulation
2396 * offload
2397 *
2398 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RX_DECAP_OFFLOAD: Hardware supports rx decapsulation
2399 * offload
2400 *
2401 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CONC_MON_RX_DECAP: Hardware supports concurrent rx
2402 * decapsulation offload and passing raw 802.11 frames for monitor iface.
2403 * If this is supported, the driver must pass both 802.3 frames for real
2404 * usage and 802.11 frames with %RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR set for monitor to
2405 * the stack.
2406 *
2407 * @NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS: number of hardware flags, used for sizing arrays
2408 */
2409 enum ieee80211_hw_flags {
2410 IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL,
2411 IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS,
2412 IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING,
2413 IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC,
2414 IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM,
2415 IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC,
2416 IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT,
2417 IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION,
2418 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS,
2419 IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK,
2420 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS,
2421 IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE,
2422 IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF,
2423 IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF,
2424 IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL,
2425 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT,
2426 IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS,
2427 IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR,
2428 IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL,
2429 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK,
2430 IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS,
2431 IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW,
2432 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE,
2433 IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF,
2434 IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY,
2435 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES,
2436 IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA,
2437 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS,
2438 IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS,
2439 IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW,
2440 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU,
2441 IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS,
2442 IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR,
2443 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER,
2444 IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS,
2445 IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU,
2446 IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST,
2447 IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK,
2448 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG,
2449 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA,
2450 IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP,
2451 IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP,
2452 IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ,
2453 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW,
2454 IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ,
2455 IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN,
2456 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID,
2457 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID,
2458 IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT,
2459 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_ENCAP_OFFLOAD,
2460 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RX_DECAP_OFFLOAD,
2461 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CONC_MON_RX_DECAP,
2462
2463 /* keep last, obviously */
2464 NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS
2465 };
2466
2467 /**
2468 * struct ieee80211_hw - hardware information and state
2469 *
2470 * This structure contains the configuration and hardware
2471 * information for an 802.11 PHY.
2472 *
2473 * @wiphy: This points to the &struct wiphy allocated for this
2474 * 802.11 PHY. You must fill in the @perm_addr and @dev
2475 * members of this structure using SET_IEEE80211_DEV()
2476 * and SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(). Additionally, all supported
2477 * bands (with channels, bitrates) are registered here.
2478 *
2479 * @conf: &struct ieee80211_conf, device configuration, don't use.
2480 *
2481 * @priv: pointer to private area that was allocated for driver use
2482 * along with this structure.
2483 *
2484 * @flags: hardware flags, see &enum ieee80211_hw_flags.
2485 *
2486 * @extra_tx_headroom: headroom to reserve in each transmit skb
2487 * for use by the driver (e.g. for transmit headers.)
2488 *
2489 * @extra_beacon_tailroom: tailroom to reserve in each beacon tx skb.
2490 * Can be used by drivers to add extra IEs.
2491 *
2492 * @max_signal: Maximum value for signal (rssi) in RX information, used
2493 * only when @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC or @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DB
2494 *
2495 * @max_listen_interval: max listen interval in units of beacon interval
2496 * that HW supports
2497 *
2498 * @queues: number of available hardware transmit queues for
2499 * data packets. WMM/QoS requires at least four, these
2500 * queues need to have configurable access parameters.
2501 *
2502 * @rate_control_algorithm: rate control algorithm for this hardware.
2503 * If unset (NULL), the default algorithm will be used. Must be
2504 * set before calling ieee80211_register_hw().
2505 *
2506 * @vif_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2507 * within &struct ieee80211_vif.
2508 * @sta_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2509 * within &struct ieee80211_sta.
2510 * @chanctx_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2511 * within &struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf.
2512 * @txq_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2513 * within @struct ieee80211_txq.
2514 *
2515 * @max_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages the hw
2516 * can handle.
2517 * @max_report_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages
2518 * the hw can report back.
2519 * @max_rate_tries: maximum number of tries for each stage
2520 *
2521 * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximum buffer size (number of
2522 * sub-frames) to be used for A-MPDU block ack receiver
2523 * aggregation.
2524 * This is only relevant if the device has restrictions on the
2525 * number of subframes, if it relies on mac80211 to do reordering
2526 * it shouldn't be set.
2527 *
2528 * @max_tx_aggregation_subframes: maximum number of subframes in an
2529 * aggregate an HT/HE device will transmit. In HT AddBA we'll
2530 * advertise a constant value of 64 as some older APs crash if
2531 * the window size is smaller (an example is LinkSys WRT120N
2532 * with FW v1.0.07 build 002 Jun 18 2012).
2533 * For AddBA to HE capable peers this value will be used.
2534 *
2535 * @max_tx_fragments: maximum number of tx buffers per (A)-MSDU, sum
2536 * of 1 + skb_shinfo(skb)->nr_frags for each skb in the frag_list.
2537 *
2538 * @offchannel_tx_hw_queue: HW queue ID to use for offchannel TX
2539 * (if %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL is set)
2540 *
2541 * @radiotap_mcs_details: lists which MCS information can the HW
2542 * reports, by default it is set to _MCS, _GI and _BW but doesn't
2543 * include _FMT. Use %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_\* values, only
2544 * adding _BW is supported today.
2545 *
2546 * @radiotap_vht_details: lists which VHT MCS information the HW reports,
2547 * the default is _GI | _BANDWIDTH.
2548 * Use the %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_VHT_KNOWN_\* values.
2549 *
2550 * @radiotap_he: HE radiotap validity flags
2551 *
2552 * @radiotap_timestamp: Information for the radiotap timestamp field; if the
2553 * @units_pos member is set to a non-negative value then the timestamp
2554 * field will be added and populated from the &struct ieee80211_rx_status
2555 * device_timestamp.
2556 * @radiotap_timestamp.units_pos: Must be set to a combination of a
2557 * IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_UNIT_* and a
2558 * IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_SPOS_* value.
2559 * @radiotap_timestamp.accuracy: If non-negative, fills the accuracy in the
2560 * radiotap field and the accuracy known flag will be set.
2561 *
2562 * @netdev_features: netdev features to be set in each netdev created
2563 * from this HW. Note that not all features are usable with mac80211,
2564 * other features will be rejected during HW registration.
2565 *
2566 * @uapsd_queues: This bitmap is included in (re)association frame to indicate
2567 * for each access category if it is uAPSD trigger-enabled and delivery-
2568 * enabled. Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_* to set this bitmap.
2569 * Each bit corresponds to different AC. Value '1' in specific bit means
2570 * that corresponding AC is both trigger- and delivery-enabled. '0' means
2571 * neither enabled.
2572 *
2573 * @uapsd_max_sp_len: maximum number of total buffered frames the WMM AP may
2574 * deliver to a WMM STA during any Service Period triggered by the WMM STA.
2575 * Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_SP_* for correct values.
2576 *
2577 * @n_cipher_schemes: a size of an array of cipher schemes definitions.
2578 * @cipher_schemes: a pointer to an array of cipher scheme definitions
2579 * supported by HW.
2580 * @max_nan_de_entries: maximum number of NAN DE functions supported by the
2581 * device.
2582 *
2583 * @tx_sk_pacing_shift: Pacing shift to set on TCP sockets when frames from
2584 * them are encountered. The default should typically not be changed,
2585 * unless the driver has good reasons for needing more buffers.
2586 *
2587 * @weight_multiplier: Driver specific airtime weight multiplier used while
2588 * refilling deficit of each TXQ.
2589 *
2590 * @max_mtu: the max mtu could be set.
2591 */
2592 struct ieee80211_hw {
2593 struct ieee80211_conf conf;
2594 struct wiphy *wiphy;
2595 const char *rate_control_algorithm;
2596 void *priv;
2597 unsigned long flags[BITS_TO_LONGS(NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS)];
2598 unsigned int extra_tx_headroom;
2599 unsigned int extra_beacon_tailroom;
2600 int vif_data_size;
2601 int sta_data_size;
2602 int chanctx_data_size;
2603 int txq_data_size;
2604 u16 queues;
2605 u16 max_listen_interval;
2606 s8 max_signal;
2607 u8 max_rates;
2608 u8 max_report_rates;
2609 u8 max_rate_tries;
2610 u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes;
2611 u16 max_tx_aggregation_subframes;
2612 u8 max_tx_fragments;
2613 u8 offchannel_tx_hw_queue;
2614 u8 radiotap_mcs_details;
2615 u16 radiotap_vht_details;
2616 struct {
2617 int units_pos;
2618 s16 accuracy;
2619 } radiotap_timestamp;
2620 netdev_features_t netdev_features;
2621 u8 uapsd_queues;
2622 u8 uapsd_max_sp_len;
2623 u8 n_cipher_schemes;
2624 const struct ieee80211_cipher_scheme *cipher_schemes;
2625 u8 max_nan_de_entries;
2626 u8 tx_sk_pacing_shift;
2627 u8 weight_multiplier;
2628 u32 max_mtu;
2629 };
2630
2631 static inline bool _ieee80211_hw_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2632 enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)
2633 {
2634 return test_bit(flg, hw->flags);
2635 }
2636 #define ieee80211_hw_check(hw, flg) _ieee80211_hw_check(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg)
2637
2638 static inline void _ieee80211_hw_set(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2639 enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)
2640 {
2641 return __set_bit(flg, hw->flags);
2642 }
2643 #define ieee80211_hw_set(hw, flg) _ieee80211_hw_set(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg)
2644
2645 /**
2646 * struct ieee80211_scan_request - hw scan request
2647 *
2648 * @ies: pointers different parts of IEs (in req.ie)
2649 * @req: cfg80211 request.
2650 */
2651 struct ieee80211_scan_request {
2652 struct ieee80211_scan_ies ies;
2653
2654 /* Keep last */
2655 struct cfg80211_scan_request req;
2656 };
2657
2658 /**
2659 * struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params - TDLS channel switch parameters
2660 *
2661 * @sta: peer this TDLS channel-switch request/response came from
2662 * @chandef: channel referenced in a TDLS channel-switch request
2663 * @action_code: see &enum ieee80211_tdls_actioncode
2664 * @status: channel-switch response status
2665 * @timestamp: time at which the frame was received
2666 * @switch_time: switch-timing parameter received in the frame
2667 * @switch_timeout: switch-timing parameter received in the frame
2668 * @tmpl_skb: TDLS switch-channel response template
2669 * @ch_sw_tm_ie: offset of the channel-switch timing IE inside @tmpl_skb
2670 */
2671 struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params {
2672 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2673 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef;
2674 u8 action_code;
2675 u32 status;
2676 u32 timestamp;
2677 u16 switch_time;
2678 u16 switch_timeout;
2679 struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb;
2680 u32 ch_sw_tm_ie;
2681 };
2682
2683 /**
2684 * wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw - return a mac80211 driver hw struct from a wiphy
2685 *
2686 * @wiphy: the &struct wiphy which we want to query
2687 *
2688 * mac80211 drivers can use this to get to their respective
2689 * &struct ieee80211_hw. Drivers wishing to get to their own private
2690 * structure can then access it via hw->priv. Note that mac802111 drivers should
2691 * not use wiphy_priv() to try to get their private driver structure as this
2692 * is already used internally by mac80211.
2693 *
2694 * Return: The mac80211 driver hw struct of @wiphy.
2695 */
2696 struct ieee80211_hw *wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw(struct wiphy *wiphy);
2697
2698 /**
2699 * SET_IEEE80211_DEV - set device for 802.11 hardware
2700 *
2701 * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the device for
2702 * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device
2703 */
2704 static inline void SET_IEEE80211_DEV(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct device *dev)
2705 {
2706 set_wiphy_dev(hw->wiphy, dev);
2707 }
2708
2709 /**
2710 * SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR - set the permanent MAC address for 802.11 hardware
2711 *
2712 * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the MAC address for
2713 * @addr: the address to set
2714 */
2715 static inline void SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, const u8 *addr)
2716 {
2717 memcpy(hw->wiphy->perm_addr, addr, ETH_ALEN);
2718 }
2719
2720 static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
2721 ieee80211_get_tx_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2722 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c)
2723 {
2724 if (WARN_ON_ONCE(c->control.rates[0].idx < 0))
2725 return NULL;
2726 return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[0].idx];
2727 }
2728
2729 static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
2730 ieee80211_get_rts_cts_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2731 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c)
2732 {
2733 if (c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx < 0)
2734 return NULL;
2735 return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx];
2736 }
2737
2738 static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
2739 ieee80211_get_alt_retry_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2740 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c, int idx)
2741 {
2742 if (c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx < 0)
2743 return NULL;
2744 return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx];
2745 }
2746
2747 /**
2748 * ieee80211_free_txskb - free TX skb
2749 * @hw: the hardware
2750 * @skb: the skb
2751 *
2752 * Free a transmit skb. Use this function when some failure
2753 * to transmit happened and thus status cannot be reported.
2754 */
2755 void ieee80211_free_txskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);
2756
2757 /**
2758 * DOC: Hardware crypto acceleration
2759 *
2760 * mac80211 is capable of taking advantage of many hardware
2761 * acceleration designs for encryption and decryption operations.
2762 *
2763 * The set_key() callback in the &struct ieee80211_ops for a given
2764 * device is called to enable hardware acceleration of encryption and
2765 * decryption. The callback takes a @sta parameter that will be NULL
2766 * for default keys or keys used for transmission only, or point to
2767 * the station information for the peer for individual keys.
2768 * Multiple transmission keys with the same key index may be used when
2769 * VLANs are configured for an access point.
2770 *
2771 * When transmitting, the TX control data will use the @hw_key_idx
2772 * selected by the driver by modifying the &struct ieee80211_key_conf
2773 * pointed to by the @key parameter to the set_key() function.
2774 *
2775 * The set_key() call for the %SET_KEY command should return 0 if
2776 * the key is now in use, -%EOPNOTSUPP or -%ENOSPC if it couldn't be
2777 * added; if you return 0 then hw_key_idx must be assigned to the
2778 * hardware key index, you are free to use the full u8 range.
2779 *
2780 * Note that in the case that the @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL flag is
2781 * set, mac80211 will not automatically fall back to software crypto if
2782 * enabling hardware crypto failed. The set_key() call may also return the
2783 * value 1 to permit this specific key/algorithm to be done in software.
2784 *
2785 * When the cmd is %DISABLE_KEY then it must succeed.
2786 *
2787 * Note that it is permissible to not decrypt a frame even if a key
2788 * for it has been uploaded to hardware, the stack will not make any
2789 * decision based on whether a key has been uploaded or not but rather
2790 * based on the receive flags.
2791 *
2792 * The &struct ieee80211_key_conf structure pointed to by the @key
2793 * parameter is guaranteed to be valid until another call to set_key()
2794 * removes it, but it can only be used as a cookie to differentiate
2795 * keys.
2796 *
2797 * In TKIP some HW need to be provided a phase 1 key, for RX decryption
2798 * acceleration (i.e. iwlwifi). Those drivers should provide update_tkip_key
2799 * handler.
2800 * The update_tkip_key() call updates the driver with the new phase 1 key.
2801 * This happens every time the iv16 wraps around (every 65536 packets). The
2802 * set_key() call will happen only once for each key (unless the AP did
2803 * rekeying), it will not include a valid phase 1 key. The valid phase 1 key is
2804 * provided by update_tkip_key only. The trigger that makes mac80211 call this
2805 * handler is software decryption with wrap around of iv16.
2806 *
2807 * The set_default_unicast_key() call updates the default WEP key index
2808 * configured to the hardware for WEP encryption type. This is required
2809 * for devices that support offload of data packets (e.g. ARP responses).
2810 *
2811 * Mac80211 drivers should set the @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CAN_REPLACE_PTK0 flag
2812 * when they are able to replace in-use PTK keys according to the following
2813 * requirements:
2814 * 1) They do not hand over frames decrypted with the old key to
2815 mac80211 once the call to set_key() with command %DISABLE_KEY has been
2816 completed when also setting @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV for any key,
2817 2) either drop or continue to use the old key for any outgoing frames queued
2818 at the time of the key deletion (including re-transmits),
2819 3) never send out a frame queued prior to the set_key() %SET_KEY command
2820 encrypted with the new key and
2821 4) never send out a frame unencrypted when it should be encrypted.
2822 Mac80211 will not queue any new frames for a deleted key to the driver.
2823 */
2824
2825 /**
2826 * DOC: Powersave support
2827 *
2828 * mac80211 has support for various powersave implementations.
2829 *
2830 * First, it can support hardware that handles all powersaving by itself,
2831 * such hardware should simply set the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS hardware
2832 * flag. In that case, it will be told about the desired powersave mode
2833 * with the %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag depending on the association status.
2834 * The hardware must take care of sending nullfunc frames when necessary,
2835 * i.e. when entering and leaving powersave mode. The hardware is required
2836 * to look at the AID in beacons and signal to the AP that it woke up when
2837 * it finds traffic directed to it.
2838 *
2839 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag enabled means that the powersave mode defined in
2840 * IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2 is enabled. This is not to be confused
2841 * with hardware wakeup and sleep states. Driver is responsible for waking
2842 * up the hardware before issuing commands to the hardware and putting it
2843 * back to sleep at appropriate times.
2844 *
2845 * When PS is enabled, hardware needs to wakeup for beacons and receive the
2846 * buffered multicast/broadcast frames after the beacon. Also it must be
2847 * possible to send frames and receive the acknowledment frame.
2848 *
2849 * Other hardware designs cannot send nullfunc frames by themselves and also
2850 * need software support for parsing the TIM bitmap. This is also supported
2851 * by mac80211 by combining the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS and
2852 * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK flags. The hardware is of course still
2853 * required to pass up beacons. The hardware is still required to handle
2854 * waking up for multicast traffic; if it cannot the driver must handle that
2855 * as best as it can, mac80211 is too slow to do that.
2856 *
2857 * Dynamic powersave is an extension to normal powersave in which the
2858 * hardware stays awake for a user-specified period of time after sending a
2859 * frame so that reply frames need not be buffered and therefore delayed to
2860 * the next wakeup. It's compromise of getting good enough latency when
2861 * there's data traffic and still saving significantly power in idle
2862 * periods.
2863 *
2864 * Dynamic powersave is simply supported by mac80211 enabling and disabling
2865 * PS based on traffic. Driver needs to only set %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS
2866 * flag and mac80211 will handle everything automatically. Additionally,
2867 * hardware having support for the dynamic PS feature may set the
2868 * %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS flag to indicate that it can support
2869 * dynamic PS mode itself. The driver needs to look at the
2870 * @dynamic_ps_timeout hardware configuration value and use it that value
2871 * whenever %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. In this case mac80211 will disable
2872 * dynamic PS feature in stack and will just keep %IEEE80211_CONF_PS
2873 * enabled whenever user has enabled powersave.
2874 *
2875 * Driver informs U-APSD client support by enabling
2876 * %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD flag. The mode is configured through the
2877 * uapsd parameter in conf_tx() operation. Hardware needs to send the QoS
2878 * Nullfunc frames and stay awake until the service period has ended. To
2879 * utilize U-APSD, dynamic powersave is disabled for voip AC and all frames
2880 * from that AC are transmitted with powersave enabled.
2881 *
2882 * Note: U-APSD client mode is not yet supported with
2883 * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK.
2884 */
2885
2886 /**
2887 * DOC: Beacon filter support
2888 *
2889 * Some hardware have beacon filter support to reduce host cpu wakeups
2890 * which will reduce system power consumption. It usually works so that
2891 * the firmware creates a checksum of the beacon but omits all constantly
2892 * changing elements (TSF, TIM etc). Whenever the checksum changes the
2893 * beacon is forwarded to the host, otherwise it will be just dropped. That
2894 * way the host will only receive beacons where some relevant information
2895 * (for example ERP protection or WMM settings) have changed.
2896 *
2897 * Beacon filter support is advertised with the %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER
2898 * interface capability. The driver needs to enable beacon filter support
2899 * whenever power save is enabled, that is %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. When
2900 * power save is enabled, the stack will not check for beacon loss and the
2901 * driver needs to notify about loss of beacons with ieee80211_beacon_loss().
2902 *
2903 * The time (or number of beacons missed) until the firmware notifies the
2904 * driver of a beacon loss event (which in turn causes the driver to call
2905 * ieee80211_beacon_loss()) should be configurable and will be controlled
2906 * by mac80211 and the roaming algorithm in the future.
2907 *
2908 * Since there may be constantly changing information elements that nothing
2909 * in the software stack cares about, we will, in the future, have mac80211
2910 * tell the driver which information elements are interesting in the sense
2911 * that we want to see changes in them. This will include
2912 *
2913 * - a list of information element IDs
2914 * - a list of OUIs for the vendor information element
2915 *
2916 * Ideally, the hardware would filter out any beacons without changes in the
2917 * requested elements, but if it cannot support that it may, at the expense
2918 * of some efficiency, filter out only a subset. For example, if the device
2919 * doesn't support checking for OUIs it should pass up all changes in all
2920 * vendor information elements.
2921 *
2922 * Note that change, for the sake of simplification, also includes information
2923 * elements appearing or disappearing from the beacon.
2924 *
2925 * Some hardware supports an "ignore list" instead, just make sure nothing
2926 * that was requested is on the ignore list, and include commonly changing
2927 * information element IDs in the ignore list, for example 11 (BSS load) and
2928 * the various vendor-assigned IEs with unknown contents (128, 129, 133-136,
2929 * 149, 150, 155, 156, 173, 176, 178, 179, 219); for forward compatibility
2930 * it could also include some currently unused IDs.
2931 *
2932 *
2933 * In addition to these capabilities, hardware should support notifying the
2934 * host of changes in the beacon RSSI. This is relevant to implement roaming
2935 * when no traffic is flowing (when traffic is flowing we see the RSSI of
2936 * the received data packets). This can consist in notifying the host when
2937 * the RSSI changes significantly or when it drops below or rises above
2938 * configurable thresholds. In the future these thresholds will also be
2939 * configured by mac80211 (which gets them from userspace) to implement
2940 * them as the roaming algorithm requires.
2941 *
2942 * If the hardware cannot implement this, the driver should ask it to
2943 * periodically pass beacon frames to the host so that software can do the
2944 * signal strength threshold checking.
2945 */
2946
2947 /**
2948 * DOC: Spatial multiplexing power save
2949 *
2950 * SMPS (Spatial multiplexing power save) is a mechanism to conserve
2951 * power in an 802.11n implementation. For details on the mechanism
2952 * and rationale, please refer to 802.11 (as amended by 802.11n-2009)
2953 * "11.2.3 SM power save".
2954 *
2955 * The mac80211 implementation is capable of sending action frames
2956 * to update the AP about the station's SMPS mode, and will instruct
2957 * the driver to enter the specific mode. It will also announce the
2958 * requested SMPS mode during the association handshake. Hardware
2959 * support for this feature is required, and can be indicated by
2960 * hardware flags.
2961 *
2962 * The default mode will be "automatic", which nl80211/cfg80211
2963 * defines to be dynamic SMPS in (regular) powersave, and SMPS
2964 * turned off otherwise.
2965 *
2966 * To support this feature, the driver must set the appropriate
2967 * hardware support flags, and handle the SMPS flag to the config()
2968 * operation. It will then with this mechanism be instructed to
2969 * enter the requested SMPS mode while associated to an HT AP.
2970 */
2971
2972 /**
2973 * DOC: Frame filtering
2974 *
2975 * mac80211 requires to see many management frames for proper
2976 * operation, and users may want to see many more frames when
2977 * in monitor mode. However, for best CPU usage and power consumption,
2978 * having as few frames as possible percolate through the stack is
2979 * desirable. Hence, the hardware should filter as much as possible.
2980 *
2981 * To achieve this, mac80211 uses filter flags (see below) to tell
2982 * the driver's configure_filter() function which frames should be
2983 * passed to mac80211 and which should be filtered out.
2984 *
2985 * Before configure_filter() is invoked, the prepare_multicast()
2986 * callback is invoked with the parameters @mc_count and @mc_list
2987 * for the combined multicast address list of all virtual interfaces.
2988 * It's use is optional, and it returns a u64 that is passed to
2989 * configure_filter(). Additionally, configure_filter() has the
2990 * arguments @changed_flags telling which flags were changed and
2991 * @total_flags with the new flag states.
2992 *
2993 * If your device has no multicast address filters your driver will
2994 * need to check both the %FIF_ALLMULTI flag and the @mc_count
2995 * parameter to see whether multicast frames should be accepted
2996 * or dropped.
2997 *
2998 * All unsupported flags in @total_flags must be cleared.
2999 * Hardware does not support a flag if it is incapable of _passing_
3000 * the frame to the stack. Otherwise the driver must ignore
3001 * the flag, but not clear it.
3002 * You must _only_ clear the flag (announce no support for the
3003 * flag to mac80211) if you are not able to pass the packet type
3004 * to the stack (so the hardware always filters it).
3005 * So for example, you should clear @FIF_CONTROL, if your hardware
3006 * always filters control frames. If your hardware always passes
3007 * control frames to the kernel and is incapable of filtering them,
3008 * you do _not_ clear the @FIF_CONTROL flag.
3009 * This rule applies to all other FIF flags as well.
3010 */
3011
3012 /**
3013 * DOC: AP support for powersaving clients
3014 *
3015 * In order to implement AP and P2P GO modes, mac80211 has support for
3016 * client powersaving, both "legacy" PS (PS-Poll/null data) and uAPSD.
3017 * There currently is no support for sAPSD.
3018 *
3019 * There is one assumption that mac80211 makes, namely that a client
3020 * will not poll with PS-Poll and trigger with uAPSD at the same time.
3021 * Both are supported, and both can be used by the same client, but
3022 * they can't be used concurrently by the same client. This simplifies
3023 * the driver code.
3024 *
3025 * The first thing to keep in mind is that there is a flag for complete
3026 * driver implementation: %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS. If this flag is set,
3027 * mac80211 expects the driver to handle most of the state machine for
3028 * powersaving clients and will ignore the PM bit in incoming frames.
3029 * Drivers then use ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() to inform mac80211 of
3030 * stations' powersave transitions. In this mode, mac80211 also doesn't
3031 * handle PS-Poll/uAPSD.
3032 *
3033 * In the mode without %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS, mac80211 will check the
3034 * PM bit in incoming frames for client powersave transitions. When a
3035 * station goes to sleep, we will stop transmitting to it. There is,
3036 * however, a race condition: a station might go to sleep while there is
3037 * data buffered on hardware queues. If the device has support for this
3038 * it will reject frames, and the driver should give the frames back to
3039 * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED flag set which will
3040 * cause mac80211 to retry the frame when the station wakes up. The
3041 * driver is also notified of powersave transitions by calling its
3042 * @sta_notify callback.
3043 *
3044 * When the station is asleep, it has three choices: it can wake up,
3045 * it can PS-Poll, or it can possibly start a uAPSD service period.
3046 * Waking up is implemented by simply transmitting all buffered (and
3047 * filtered) frames to the station. This is the easiest case. When
3048 * the station sends a PS-Poll or a uAPSD trigger frame, mac80211
3049 * will inform the driver of this with the @allow_buffered_frames
3050 * callback; this callback is optional. mac80211 will then transmit
3051 * the frames as usual and set the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER
3052 * on each frame. The last frame in the service period (or the only
3053 * response to a PS-Poll) also has %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set to
3054 * indicate that it ends the service period; as this frame must have
3055 * TX status report it also sets %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS.
3056 * When TX status is reported for this frame, the service period is
3057 * marked has having ended and a new one can be started by the peer.
3058 *
3059 * Additionally, non-bufferable MMPDUs can also be transmitted by
3060 * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER set in them.
3061 *
3062 * Another race condition can happen on some devices like iwlwifi
3063 * when there are frames queued for the station and it wakes up
3064 * or polls; the frames that are already queued could end up being
3065 * transmitted first instead, causing reordering and/or wrong
3066 * processing of the EOSP. The cause is that allowing frames to be
3067 * transmitted to a certain station is out-of-band communication to
3068 * the device. To allow this problem to be solved, the driver can
3069 * call ieee80211_sta_block_awake() if frames are buffered when it
3070 * is notified that the station went to sleep. When all these frames
3071 * have been filtered (see above), it must call the function again
3072 * to indicate that the station is no longer blocked.
3073 *
3074 * If the driver buffers frames in the driver for aggregation in any
3075 * way, it must use the ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() call when it is
3076 * notified of the station going to sleep to inform mac80211 of any
3077 * TIDs that have frames buffered. Note that when a station wakes up
3078 * this information is reset (hence the requirement to call it when
3079 * informed of the station going to sleep). Then, when a service
3080 * period starts for any reason, @release_buffered_frames is called
3081 * with the number of frames to be released and which TIDs they are
3082 * to come from. In this case, the driver is responsible for setting
3083 * the EOSP (for uAPSD) and MORE_DATA bits in the released frames,
3084 * to help the @more_data parameter is passed to tell the driver if
3085 * there is more data on other TIDs -- the TIDs to release frames
3086 * from are ignored since mac80211 doesn't know how many frames the
3087 * buffers for those TIDs contain.
3088 *
3089 * If the driver also implement GO mode, where absence periods may
3090 * shorten service periods (or abort PS-Poll responses), it must
3091 * filter those response frames except in the case of frames that
3092 * are buffered in the driver -- those must remain buffered to avoid
3093 * reordering. Because it is possible that no frames are released
3094 * in this case, the driver must call ieee80211_sta_eosp()
3095 * to indicate to mac80211 that the service period ended anyway.
3096 *
3097 * Finally, if frames from multiple TIDs are released from mac80211
3098 * but the driver might reorder them, it must clear & set the flags
3099 * appropriately (only the last frame may have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP)
3100 * and also take care of the EOSP and MORE_DATA bits in the frame.
3101 * The driver may also use ieee80211_sta_eosp() in this case.
3102 *
3103 * Note that if the driver ever buffers frames other than QoS-data
3104 * frames, it must take care to never send a non-QoS-data frame as
3105 * the last frame in a service period, adding a QoS-nulldata frame
3106 * after a non-QoS-data frame if needed.
3107 */
3108
3109 /**
3110 * DOC: HW queue control
3111 *
3112 * Before HW queue control was introduced, mac80211 only had a single static
3113 * assignment of per-interface AC software queues to hardware queues. This
3114 * was problematic for a few reasons:
3115 * 1) off-channel transmissions might get stuck behind other frames
3116 * 2) multiple virtual interfaces couldn't be handled correctly
3117 * 3) after-DTIM frames could get stuck behind other frames
3118 *
3119 * To solve this, hardware typically uses multiple different queues for all
3120 * the different usages, and this needs to be propagated into mac80211 so it
3121 * won't have the same problem with the software queues.
3122 *
3123 * Therefore, mac80211 now offers the %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL capability
3124 * flag that tells it that the driver implements its own queue control. To do
3125 * so, the driver will set up the various queues in each &struct ieee80211_vif
3126 * and the offchannel queue in &struct ieee80211_hw. In response, mac80211 will
3127 * use those queue IDs in the hw_queue field of &struct ieee80211_tx_info and
3128 * if necessary will queue the frame on the right software queue that mirrors
3129 * the hardware queue.
3130 * Additionally, the driver has to then use these HW queue IDs for the queue
3131 * management functions (ieee80211_stop_queue() et al.)
3132 *
3133 * The driver is free to set up the queue mappings as needed, multiple virtual
3134 * interfaces may map to the same hardware queues if needed. The setup has to
3135 * happen during add_interface or change_interface callbacks. For example, a
3136 * driver supporting station+station and station+AP modes might decide to have
3137 * 10 hardware queues to handle different scenarios:
3138 *
3139 * 4 AC HW queues for 1st vif: 0, 1, 2, 3
3140 * 4 AC HW queues for 2nd vif: 4, 5, 6, 7
3141 * after-DTIM queue for AP: 8
3142 * off-channel queue: 9
3143 *
3144 * It would then set up the hardware like this:
3145 * hw.offchannel_tx_hw_queue = 9
3146 *
3147 * and the first virtual interface that is added as follows:
3148 * vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VO] = 0
3149 * vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VI] = 1
3150 * vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BE] = 2
3151 * vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BK] = 3
3152 * vif.cab_queue = 8 // if AP mode, otherwise %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE
3153 * and the second virtual interface with 4-7.
3154 *
3155 * If queue 6 gets full, for example, mac80211 would only stop the second
3156 * virtual interface's BE queue since virtual interface queues are per AC.
3157 *
3158 * Note that the vif.cab_queue value should be set to %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE
3159 * whenever the queue is not used (i.e. the interface is not in AP mode) if the
3160 * queue could potentially be shared since mac80211 will look at cab_queue when
3161 * a queue is stopped/woken even if the interface is not in AP mode.
3162 */
3163
3164 /**
3165 * enum ieee80211_filter_flags - hardware filter flags
3166 *
3167 * These flags determine what the filter in hardware should be
3168 * programmed to let through and what should not be passed to the
3169 * stack. It is always safe to pass more frames than requested,
3170 * but this has negative impact on power consumption.
3171 *
3172 * @FIF_ALLMULTI: pass all multicast frames, this is used if requested
3173 * by the user or if the hardware is not capable of filtering by
3174 * multicast address.
3175 *
3176 * @FIF_FCSFAIL: pass frames with failed FCS (but you need to set the
3177 * %RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC for them)
3178 *
3179 * @FIF_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with failed PLCP CRC (but you need to set
3180 * the %RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC for them
3181 *
3182 * @FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC: This flag is set during scanning to indicate
3183 * to the hardware that it should not filter beacons or probe responses
3184 * by BSSID. Filtering them can greatly reduce the amount of processing
3185 * mac80211 needs to do and the amount of CPU wakeups, so you should
3186 * honour this flag if possible.
3187 *
3188 * @FIF_CONTROL: pass control frames (except for PS Poll) addressed to this
3189 * station
3190 *
3191 * @FIF_OTHER_BSS: pass frames destined to other BSSes
3192 *
3193 * @FIF_PSPOLL: pass PS Poll frames
3194 *
3195 * @FIF_PROBE_REQ: pass probe request frames
3196 *
3197 * @FIF_MCAST_ACTION: pass multicast Action frames
3198 */
3199 enum ieee80211_filter_flags {
3200 FIF_ALLMULTI = 1<<1,
3201 FIF_FCSFAIL = 1<<2,
3202 FIF_PLCPFAIL = 1<<3,
3203 FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC = 1<<4,
3204 FIF_CONTROL = 1<<5,
3205 FIF_OTHER_BSS = 1<<6,
3206 FIF_PSPOLL = 1<<7,
3207 FIF_PROBE_REQ = 1<<8,
3208 FIF_MCAST_ACTION = 1<<9,
3209 };
3210
3211 /**
3212 * enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action - A-MPDU actions
3213 *
3214 * These flags are used with the ampdu_action() callback in
3215 * &struct ieee80211_ops to indicate which action is needed.
3216 *
3217 * Note that drivers MUST be able to deal with a TX aggregation
3218 * session being stopped even before they OK'ed starting it by
3219 * calling ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe, because the peer
3220 * might receive the addBA frame and send a delBA right away!
3221 *
3222 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START: start RX aggregation
3223 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP: stop RX aggregation
3224 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START: start TX aggregation, the driver must either
3225 * call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() or
3226 * call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() with status
3227 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA to delay addba after
3228 * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe is called, or just return the special
3229 * status %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE.
3230 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL: TX aggregation has become operational
3231 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT: stop TX aggregation but continue transmitting
3232 * queued packets, now unaggregated. After all packets are transmitted the
3233 * driver has to call ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe().
3234 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH: stop TX aggregation and flush all packets,
3235 * called when the station is removed. There's no need or reason to call
3236 * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() in this case as mac80211 assumes the
3237 * session is gone and removes the station.
3238 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT: called when TX aggregation is stopped
3239 * but the driver hasn't called ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() yet and
3240 * now the connection is dropped and the station will be removed. Drivers
3241 * should clean up and drop remaining packets when this is called.
3242 */
3243 enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action {
3244 IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START,
3245 IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP,
3246 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START,
3247 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT,
3248 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH,
3249 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT,
3250 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL,
3251 };
3252
3253 #define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE 1
3254 #define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA 2
3255
3256 /**
3257 * struct ieee80211_ampdu_params - AMPDU action parameters
3258 *
3259 * @action: the ampdu action, value from %ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action.
3260 * @sta: peer of this AMPDU session
3261 * @tid: tid of the BA session
3262 * @ssn: start sequence number of the session. TX/RX_STOP can pass 0. When
3263 * action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START the driver passes back the
3264 * actual ssn value used to start the session and writes the value here.
3265 * @buf_size: reorder buffer size (number of subframes). Valid only when the
3266 * action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START or
3267 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL
3268 * @amsdu: indicates the peer's ability to receive A-MSDU within A-MPDU.
3269 * valid when the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL
3270 * @timeout: BA session timeout. Valid only when the action is set to
3271 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START
3272 */
3273 struct ieee80211_ampdu_params {
3274 enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action action;
3275 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
3276 u16 tid;
3277 u16 ssn;
3278 u16 buf_size;
3279 bool amsdu;
3280 u16 timeout;
3281 };
3282
3283 /**
3284 * enum ieee80211_frame_release_type - frame release reason
3285 * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL: frame released for PS-Poll
3286 * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD: frame(s) released due to
3287 * frame received on trigger-enabled AC
3288 */
3289 enum ieee80211_frame_release_type {
3290 IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL,
3291 IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD,
3292 };
3293
3294 /**
3295 * enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed - flags to indicate what changed
3296 *
3297 * @IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED: The bandwidth that can be used to transmit
3298 * to this station changed. The actual bandwidth is in the station
3299 * information -- for HT20/40 the IEEE80211_HT_CAP_SUP_WIDTH_20_40
3300 * flag changes, for HT and VHT the bandwidth field changes.
3301 * @IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED: The SMPS state of the station changed.
3302 * @IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED: The supported rate set of this peer
3303 * changed (in IBSS mode) due to discovering more information about
3304 * the peer.
3305 * @IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED: N_SS (number of spatial streams) was changed
3306 * by the peer
3307 */
3308 enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed {
3309 IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED = BIT(0),
3310 IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED = BIT(1),
3311 IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED = BIT(2),
3312 IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED = BIT(3),
3313 };
3314
3315 /**
3316 * enum ieee80211_roc_type - remain on channel type
3317 *
3318 * With the support for multi channel contexts and multi channel operations,
3319 * remain on channel operations might be limited/deferred/aborted by other
3320 * flows/operations which have higher priority (and vice versa).
3321 * Specifying the ROC type can be used by devices to prioritize the ROC
3322 * operations compared to other operations/flows.
3323 *
3324 * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL: There are no special requirements for this ROC.
3325 * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX: The remain on channel request is required
3326 * for sending management frames offchannel.
3327 */
3328 enum ieee80211_roc_type {
3329 IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL = 0,
3330 IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX,
3331 };
3332
3333 /**
3334 * enum ieee80211_reconfig_type - reconfig type
3335 *
3336 * This enum is used by the reconfig_complete() callback to indicate what
3337 * reconfiguration type was completed.
3338 *
3339 * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART: hw restart type
3340 * (also due to resume() callback returning 1)
3341 * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND: suspend type (regardless
3342 * of wowlan configuration)
3343 */
3344 enum ieee80211_reconfig_type {
3345 IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART,
3346 IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND,
3347 };
3348
3349 /**
3350 * struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info - prepare TX information
3351 * @duration: if non-zero, hint about the required duration,
3352 * only used with the mgd_prepare_tx() method.
3353 * @subtype: frame subtype (auth, (re)assoc, deauth, disassoc)
3354 * @success: whether the frame exchange was successful, only
3355 * used with the mgd_complete_tx() method, and then only
3356 * valid for auth and (re)assoc.
3357 */
3358 struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info {
3359 u16 duration;
3360 u16 subtype;
3361 u8 success:1;
3362 };
3363
3364 /**
3365 * struct ieee80211_ops - callbacks from mac80211 to the driver
3366 *
3367 * This structure contains various callbacks that the driver may
3368 * handle or, in some cases, must handle, for example to configure
3369 * the hardware to a new channel or to transmit a frame.
3370 *
3371 * @tx: Handler that 802.11 module calls for each transmitted frame.
3372 * skb contains the buffer starting from the IEEE 802.11 header.
3373 * The low-level driver should send the frame out based on
3374 * configuration in the TX control data. This handler should,
3375 * preferably, never fail and stop queues appropriately.
3376 * Must be atomic.
3377 *
3378 * @start: Called before the first netdevice attached to the hardware
3379 * is enabled. This should turn on the hardware and must turn on
3380 * frame reception (for possibly enabled monitor interfaces.)
3381 * Returns negative error codes, these may be seen in userspace,
3382 * or zero.
3383 * When the device is started it should not have a MAC address
3384 * to avoid acknowledging frames before a non-monitor device
3385 * is added.
3386 * Must be implemented and can sleep.
3387 *
3388 * @stop: Called after last netdevice attached to the hardware
3389 * is disabled. This should turn off the hardware (at least
3390 * it must turn off frame reception.)
3391 * May be called right after add_interface if that rejects
3392 * an interface. If you added any work onto the mac80211 workqueue
3393 * you should ensure to cancel it on this callback.
3394 * Must be implemented and can sleep.
3395 *
3396 * @suspend: Suspend the device; mac80211 itself will quiesce before and
3397 * stop transmitting and doing any other configuration, and then
3398 * ask the device to suspend. This is only invoked when WoWLAN is
3399 * configured, otherwise the device is deconfigured completely and
3400 * reconfigured at resume time.
3401 * The driver may also impose special conditions under which it
3402 * wants to use the "normal" suspend (deconfigure), say if it only
3403 * supports WoWLAN when the device is associated. In this case, it
3404 * must return 1 from this function.
3405 *
3406 * @resume: If WoWLAN was configured, this indicates that mac80211 is
3407 * now resuming its operation, after this the device must be fully
3408 * functional again. If this returns an error, the only way out is
3409 * to also unregister the device. If it returns 1, then mac80211
3410 * will also go through the regular complete restart on resume.
3411 *
3412 * @set_wakeup: Enable or disable wakeup when WoWLAN configuration is
3413 * modified. The reason is that device_set_wakeup_enable() is
3414 * supposed to be called when the configuration changes, not only
3415 * in suspend().
3416 *
3417 * @add_interface: Called when a netdevice attached to the hardware is
3418 * enabled. Because it is not called for monitor mode devices, @start
3419 * and @stop must be implemented.
3420 * The driver should perform any initialization it needs before
3421 * the device can be enabled. The initial configuration for the
3422 * interface is given in the conf parameter.
3423 * The callback may refuse to add an interface by returning a
3424 * negative error code (which will be seen in userspace.)
3425 * Must be implemented and can sleep.
3426 *
3427 * @change_interface: Called when a netdevice changes type. This callback
3428 * is optional, but only if it is supported can interface types be
3429 * switched while the interface is UP. The callback may sleep.
3430 * Note that while an interface is being switched, it will not be
3431 * found by the interface iteration callbacks.
3432 *
3433 * @remove_interface: Notifies a driver that an interface is going down.
3434 * The @stop callback is called after this if it is the last interface
3435 * and no monitor interfaces are present.
3436 * When all interfaces are removed, the MAC address in the hardware
3437 * must be cleared so the device no longer acknowledges packets,
3438 * the mac_addr member of the conf structure is, however, set to the
3439 * MAC address of the device going away.
3440 * Hence, this callback must be implemented. It can sleep.
3441 *
3442 * @config: Handler for configuration requests. IEEE 802.11 code calls this
3443 * function to change hardware configuration, e.g., channel.
3444 * This function should never fail but returns a negative error code
3445 * if it does. The callback can sleep.
3446 *
3447 * @bss_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to BSS
3448 * parameters that may vary during BSS's lifespan, and may affect low
3449 * level driver (e.g. assoc/disassoc status, erp parameters).
3450 * This function should not be used if no BSS has been set, unless
3451 * for association indication. The @changed parameter indicates which
3452 * of the bss parameters has changed when a call is made. The callback
3453 * can sleep.
3454 *
3455 * @prepare_multicast: Prepare for multicast filter configuration.
3456 * This callback is optional, and its return value is passed
3457 * to configure_filter(). This callback must be atomic.
3458 *
3459 * @configure_filter: Configure the device's RX filter.
3460 * See the section "Frame filtering" for more information.
3461 * This callback must be implemented and can sleep.
3462 *
3463 * @config_iface_filter: Configure the interface's RX filter.
3464 * This callback is optional and is used to configure which frames
3465 * should be passed to mac80211. The filter_flags is the combination
3466 * of FIF_* flags. The changed_flags is a bit mask that indicates
3467 * which flags are changed.
3468 * This callback can sleep.
3469 *
3470 * @set_tim: Set TIM bit. mac80211 calls this function when a TIM bit
3471 * must be set or cleared for a given STA. Must be atomic.
3472 *
3473 * @set_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration"
3474 * This callback is only called between add_interface and
3475 * remove_interface calls, i.e. while the given virtual interface
3476 * is enabled.
3477 * Returns a negative error code if the key can't be added.
3478 * The callback can sleep.
3479 *
3480 * @update_tkip_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration"
3481 * This callback will be called in the context of Rx. Called for drivers
3482 * which set IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_TKIP_REQ_RX_P1_KEY.
3483 * The callback must be atomic.
3484 *
3485 * @set_rekey_data: If the device supports GTK rekeying, for example while the
3486 * host is suspended, it can assign this callback to retrieve the data
3487 * necessary to do GTK rekeying, this is the KEK, KCK and replay counter.
3488 * After rekeying was done it should (for example during resume) notify
3489 * userspace of the new replay counter using ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify().
3490 *
3491 * @set_default_unicast_key: Set the default (unicast) key index, useful for
3492 * WEP when the device sends data packets autonomously, e.g. for ARP
3493 * offloading. The index can be 0-3, or -1 for unsetting it.
3494 *
3495 * @hw_scan: Ask the hardware to service the scan request, no need to start
3496 * the scan state machine in stack. The scan must honour the channel
3497 * configuration done by the regulatory agent in the wiphy's
3498 * registered bands. The hardware (or the driver) needs to make sure
3499 * that power save is disabled.
3500 * The @req ie/ie_len members are rewritten by mac80211 to contain the
3501 * entire IEs after the SSID, so that drivers need not look at these
3502 * at all but just send them after the SSID -- mac80211 includes the
3503 * (extended) supported rates and HT information (where applicable).
3504 * When the scan finishes, ieee80211_scan_completed() must be called;
3505 * note that it also must be called when the scan cannot finish due to
3506 * any error unless this callback returned a negative error code.
3507 * This callback is also allowed to return the special return value 1,
3508 * this indicates that hardware scan isn't desirable right now and a
3509 * software scan should be done instead. A driver wishing to use this
3510 * capability must ensure its (hardware) scan capabilities aren't
3511 * advertised as more capable than mac80211's software scan is.
3512 * The callback can sleep.
3513 *
3514 * @cancel_hw_scan: Ask the low-level tp cancel the active hw scan.
3515 * The driver should ask the hardware to cancel the scan (if possible),
3516 * but the scan will be completed only after the driver will call
3517 * ieee80211_scan_completed().
3518 * This callback is needed for wowlan, to prevent enqueueing a new
3519 * scan_work after the low-level driver was already suspended.
3520 * The callback can sleep.
3521 *
3522 * @sched_scan_start: Ask the hardware to start scanning repeatedly at
3523 * specific intervals. The driver must call the
3524 * ieee80211_sched_scan_results() function whenever it finds results.
3525 * This process will continue until sched_scan_stop is called.
3526 *
3527 * @sched_scan_stop: Tell the hardware to stop an ongoing scheduled scan.
3528 * In this case, ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped() must not be called.
3529 *
3530 * @sw_scan_start: Notifier function that is called just before a software scan
3531 * is started. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need this notification.
3532 * The mac_addr parameter allows supporting NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR,
3533 * the driver may set the NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR flag if it
3534 * can use this parameter. The callback can sleep.
3535 *
3536 * @sw_scan_complete: Notifier function that is called just after a
3537 * software scan finished. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need
3538 * this notification.
3539 * The callback can sleep.
3540 *
3541 * @get_stats: Return low-level statistics.
3542 * Returns zero if statistics are available.
3543 * The callback can sleep.
3544 *
3545 * @get_key_seq: If your device implements encryption in hardware and does
3546 * IV/PN assignment then this callback should be provided to read the
3547 * IV/PN for the given key from hardware.
3548 * The callback must be atomic.
3549 *
3550 * @set_frag_threshold: Configuration of fragmentation threshold. Assign this
3551 * if the device does fragmentation by itself. Note that to prevent the
3552 * stack from doing fragmentation IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG
3553 * should be set as well.
3554 * The callback can sleep.
3555 *
3556 * @set_rts_threshold: Configuration of RTS threshold (if device needs it)
3557 * The callback can sleep.
3558 *
3559 * @sta_add: Notifies low level driver about addition of an associated station,
3560 * AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. This callback can sleep.
3561 *
3562 * @sta_remove: Notifies low level driver about removal of an associated
3563 * station, AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. Note that after the callback
3564 * returns it isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected;
3565 * no RCU grace period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing
3566 * the station. See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed.
3567 * This callback can sleep.
3568 *
3569 * @sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
3570 * when a station is added to mac80211's station list. This callback
3571 * should be within a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This
3572 * callback can sleep.
3573 *
3574 * @sta_notify: Notifies low level driver about power state transition of an
3575 * associated station, AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. For a VIF operating
3576 * in AP mode, this callback will not be called when the flag
3577 * %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS is set. Must be atomic.
3578 *
3579 * @sta_set_txpwr: Configure the station tx power. This callback set the tx
3580 * power for the station.
3581 * This callback can sleep.
3582 *
3583 * @sta_state: Notifies low level driver about state transition of a
3584 * station (which can be the AP, a client, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc.)
3585 * This callback is mutually exclusive with @sta_add/@sta_remove.
3586 * It must not fail for down transitions but may fail for transitions
3587 * up the list of states. Also note that after the callback returns it
3588 * isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected - no RCU grace
3589 * period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing the station.
3590 * See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed.
3591 * The callback can sleep.
3592 *
3593 * @sta_pre_rcu_remove: Notify driver about station removal before RCU
3594 * synchronisation. This is useful if a driver needs to have station
3595 * pointers protected using RCU, it can then use this call to clear
3596 * the pointers instead of waiting for an RCU grace period to elapse
3597 * in @sta_state.
3598 * The callback can sleep.
3599 *
3600 * @sta_rc_update: Notifies the driver of changes to the bitrates that can be
3601 * used to transmit to the station. The changes are advertised with bits
3602 * from &enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed and the values are reflected
3603 * in the station data. This callback should only be used when the driver
3604 * uses hardware rate control (%IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL) since
3605 * otherwise the rate control algorithm is notified directly.
3606 * Must be atomic.
3607 * @sta_rate_tbl_update: Notifies the driver that the rate table changed. This
3608 * is only used if the configured rate control algorithm actually uses
3609 * the new rate table API, and is therefore optional. Must be atomic.
3610 *
3611 * @sta_statistics: Get statistics for this station. For example with beacon
3612 * filtering, the statistics kept by mac80211 might not be accurate, so
3613 * let the driver pre-fill the statistics. The driver can fill most of
3614 * the values (indicating which by setting the filled bitmap), but not
3615 * all of them make sense - see the source for which ones are possible.
3616 * Statistics that the driver doesn't fill will be filled by mac80211.
3617 * The callback can sleep.
3618 *
3619 * @conf_tx: Configure TX queue parameters (EDCF (aifs, cw_min, cw_max),
3620 * bursting) for a hardware TX queue.
3621 * Returns a negative error code on failure.
3622 * The callback can sleep.
3623 *
3624 * @get_tsf: Get the current TSF timer value from firmware/hardware. Currently,
3625 * this is only used for IBSS mode BSSID merging and debugging. Is not a
3626 * required function.
3627 * The callback can sleep.
3628 *
3629 * @set_tsf: Set the TSF timer to the specified value in the firmware/hardware.
3630 * Currently, this is only used for IBSS mode debugging. Is not a
3631 * required function.
3632 * The callback can sleep.
3633 *
3634 * @offset_tsf: Offset the TSF timer by the specified value in the
3635 * firmware/hardware. Preferred to set_tsf as it avoids delay between
3636 * calling set_tsf() and hardware getting programmed, which will show up
3637 * as TSF delay. Is not a required function.
3638 * The callback can sleep.
3639 *
3640 * @reset_tsf: Reset the TSF timer and allow firmware/hardware to synchronize
3641 * with other STAs in the IBSS. This is only used in IBSS mode. This
3642 * function is optional if the firmware/hardware takes full care of
3643 * TSF synchronization.
3644 * The callback can sleep.
3645 *
3646 * @tx_last_beacon: Determine whether the last IBSS beacon was sent by us.
3647 * This is needed only for IBSS mode and the result of this function is
3648 * used to determine whether to reply to Probe Requests.
3649 * Returns non-zero if this device sent the last beacon.
3650 * The callback can sleep.
3651 *
3652 * @get_survey: Return per-channel survey information
3653 *
3654 * @rfkill_poll: Poll rfkill hardware state. If you need this, you also
3655 * need to set wiphy->rfkill_poll to %true before registration,
3656 * and need to call wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state() in the callback.
3657 * The callback can sleep.
3658 *
3659 * @set_coverage_class: Set slot time for given coverage class as specified
3660 * in IEEE 802.11-2007 section 17.3.8.6 and modify ACK timeout
3661 * accordingly; coverage class equals to -1 to enable ACK timeout
3662 * estimation algorithm (dynack). To disable dynack set valid value for
3663 * coverage class. This callback is not required and may sleep.
3664 *
3665 * @testmode_cmd: Implement a cfg80211 test mode command. The passed @vif may
3666 * be %NULL. The callback can sleep.
3667 * @testmode_dump: Implement a cfg80211 test mode dump. The callback can sleep.
3668 *
3669 * @flush: Flush all pending frames from the hardware queue, making sure
3670 * that the hardware queues are empty. The @queues parameter is a bitmap
3671 * of queues to flush, which is useful if different virtual interfaces
3672 * use different hardware queues; it may also indicate all queues.
3673 * If the parameter @drop is set to %true, pending frames may be dropped.
3674 * Note that vif can be NULL.
3675 * The callback can sleep.
3676 *
3677 * @channel_switch: Drivers that need (or want) to offload the channel
3678 * switch operation for CSAs received from the AP may implement this
3679 * callback. They must then call ieee80211_chswitch_done() to indicate
3680 * completion of the channel switch.
3681 *
3682 * @set_antenna: Set antenna configuration (tx_ant, rx_ant) on the device.
3683 * Parameters are bitmaps of allowed antennas to use for TX/RX. Drivers may
3684 * reject TX/RX mask combinations they cannot support by returning -EINVAL
3685 * (also see nl80211.h @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX).
3686 *
3687 * @get_antenna: Get current antenna configuration from device (tx_ant, rx_ant).
3688 *
3689 * @remain_on_channel: Starts an off-channel period on the given channel, must
3690 * call back to ieee80211_ready_on_channel() when on that channel. Note
3691 * that normal channel traffic is not stopped as this is intended for hw
3692 * offload. Frames to transmit on the off-channel channel are transmitted
3693 * normally except for the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN flag. When the
3694 * duration (which will always be non-zero) expires, the driver must call
3695 * ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired().
3696 * Note that this callback may be called while the device is in IDLE and
3697 * must be accepted in this case.
3698 * This callback may sleep.
3699 * @cancel_remain_on_channel: Requests that an ongoing off-channel period is
3700 * aborted before it expires. This callback may sleep.
3701 *
3702 * @set_ringparam: Set tx and rx ring sizes.
3703 *
3704 * @get_ringparam: Get tx and rx ring current and maximum sizes.
3705 *
3706 * @tx_frames_pending: Check if there is any pending frame in the hardware
3707 * queues before entering power save.
3708 *
3709 * @set_bitrate_mask: Set a mask of rates to be used for rate control selection
3710 * when transmitting a frame. Currently only legacy rates are handled.
3711 * The callback can sleep.
3712 * @event_callback: Notify driver about any event in mac80211. See
3713 * &enum ieee80211_event_type for the different types.
3714 * The callback must be atomic.
3715 *
3716 * @release_buffered_frames: Release buffered frames according to the given
3717 * parameters. In the case where the driver buffers some frames for
3718 * sleeping stations mac80211 will use this callback to tell the driver
3719 * to release some frames, either for PS-poll or uAPSD.
3720 * Note that if the @more_data parameter is %false the driver must check
3721 * if there are more frames on the given TIDs, and if there are more than
3722 * the frames being released then it must still set the more-data bit in
3723 * the frame. If the @more_data parameter is %true, then of course the
3724 * more-data bit must always be set.
3725 * The @tids parameter tells the driver which TIDs to release frames
3726 * from, for PS-poll it will always have only a single bit set.
3727 * In the case this is used for a PS-poll initiated release, the
3728 * @num_frames parameter will always be 1 so code can be shared. In
3729 * this case the driver must also set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag
3730 * on the TX status (and must report TX status) so that the PS-poll
3731 * period is properly ended. This is used to avoid sending multiple
3732 * responses for a retried PS-poll frame.
3733 * In the case this is used for uAPSD, the @num_frames parameter may be
3734 * bigger than one, but the driver may send fewer frames (it must send
3735 * at least one, however). In this case it is also responsible for
3736 * setting the EOSP flag in the QoS header of the frames. Also, when the
3737 * service period ends, the driver must set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP
3738 * on the last frame in the SP. Alternatively, it may call the function
3739 * ieee80211_sta_eosp() to inform mac80211 of the end of the SP.
3740 * This callback must be atomic.
3741 * @allow_buffered_frames: Prepare device to allow the given number of frames
3742 * to go out to the given station. The frames will be sent by mac80211
3743 * via the usual TX path after this call. The TX information for frames
3744 * released will also have the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER flag set
3745 * and the last one will also have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set. In case
3746 * frames from multiple TIDs are released and the driver might reorder
3747 * them between the TIDs, it must set the %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag
3748 * on the last frame and clear it on all others and also handle the EOSP
3749 * bit in the QoS header correctly. Alternatively, it can also call the
3750 * ieee80211_sta_eosp() function.
3751 * The @tids parameter is a bitmap and tells the driver which TIDs the
3752 * frames will be on; it will at most have two bits set.
3753 * This callback must be atomic.
3754 *
3755 * @get_et_sset_count: Ethtool API to get string-set count.
3756 *
3757 * @get_et_stats: Ethtool API to get a set of u64 stats.
3758 *
3759 * @get_et_strings: Ethtool API to get a set of strings to describe stats
3760 * and perhaps other supported types of ethtool data-sets.
3761 *
3762 * @mgd_prepare_tx: Prepare for transmitting a management frame for association
3763 * before associated. In multi-channel scenarios, a virtual interface is
3764 * bound to a channel before it is associated, but as it isn't associated
3765 * yet it need not necessarily be given airtime, in particular since any
3766 * transmission to a P2P GO needs to be synchronized against the GO's
3767 * powersave state. mac80211 will call this function before transmitting a
3768 * management frame prior to having successfully associated to allow the
3769 * driver to give it channel time for the transmission, to get a response
3770 * and to be able to synchronize with the GO.
3771 * For drivers that set %IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP, mac80211
3772 * would also call this function before transmitting a deauthentication
3773 * frame in case that no beacon was heard from the AP/P2P GO.
3774 * The callback will be called before each transmission and upon return
3775 * mac80211 will transmit the frame right away.
3776 * Additional information is passed in the &struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info
3777 * data. If duration there is greater than zero, mac80211 hints to the
3778 * driver the duration for which the operation is requested.
3779 * The callback is optional and can (should!) sleep.
3780 * @mgd_complete_tx: Notify the driver that the response frame for a previously
3781 * transmitted frame announced with @mgd_prepare_tx was received, the data
3782 * is filled similarly to @mgd_prepare_tx though the duration is not used.
3783 *
3784 * @mgd_protect_tdls_discover: Protect a TDLS discovery session. After sending
3785 * a TDLS discovery-request, we expect a reply to arrive on the AP's
3786 * channel. We must stay on the channel (no PSM, scan, etc.), since a TDLS
3787 * setup-response is a direct packet not buffered by the AP.
3788 * mac80211 will call this function just before the transmission of a TDLS
3789 * discovery-request. The recommended period of protection is at least
3790 * 2 * (DTIM period).
3791 * The callback is optional and can sleep.
3792 *
3793 * @add_chanctx: Notifies device driver about new channel context creation.
3794 * This callback may sleep.
3795 * @remove_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context destruction.
3796 * This callback may sleep.
3797 * @change_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context changes that
3798 * may happen when combining different virtual interfaces on the same
3799 * channel context with different settings
3800 * This callback may sleep.
3801 * @assign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being bound
3802 * to vif. Possible use is for hw queue remapping.
3803 * This callback may sleep.
3804 * @unassign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being
3805 * unbound from vif.
3806 * This callback may sleep.
3807 * @switch_vif_chanctx: switch a number of vifs from one chanctx to
3808 * another, as specified in the list of
3809 * @ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch passed to the driver, according
3810 * to the mode defined in &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode.
3811 * This callback may sleep.
3812 *
3813 * @start_ap: Start operation on the AP interface, this is called after all the
3814 * information in bss_conf is set and beacon can be retrieved. A channel
3815 * context is bound before this is called. Note that if the driver uses
3816 * software scan or ROC, this (and @stop_ap) isn't called when the AP is
3817 * just "paused" for scanning/ROC, which is indicated by the beacon being
3818 * disabled/enabled via @bss_info_changed.
3819 * @stop_ap: Stop operation on the AP interface.
3820 *
3821 * @reconfig_complete: Called after a call to ieee80211_restart_hw() and
3822 * during resume, when the reconfiguration has completed.
3823 * This can help the driver implement the reconfiguration step (and
3824 * indicate mac80211 is ready to receive frames).
3825 * This callback may sleep.
3826 *
3827 * @ipv6_addr_change: IPv6 address assignment on the given interface changed.
3828 * Currently, this is only called for managed or P2P client interfaces.
3829 * This callback is optional; it must not sleep.
3830 *
3831 * @channel_switch_beacon: Starts a channel switch to a new channel.
3832 * Beacons are modified to include CSA or ECSA IEs before calling this
3833 * function. The corresponding count fields in these IEs must be
3834 * decremented, and when they reach 1 the driver must call
3835 * ieee80211_csa_finish(). Drivers which use ieee80211_beacon_get()
3836 * get the csa counter decremented by mac80211, but must check if it is
3837 * 1 using ieee80211_beacon_counter_is_complete() after the beacon has been
3838 * transmitted and then call ieee80211_csa_finish().
3839 * If the CSA count starts as zero or 1, this function will not be called,
3840 * since there won't be any time to beacon before the switch anyway.
3841 * @pre_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
3842 * before a channel switch procedure is started (ie. when a STA
3843 * gets a CSA or a userspace initiated channel-switch), allowing
3844 * the driver to prepare for the channel switch.
3845 * @post_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
3846 * after a channel switch procedure is completed, allowing the
3847 * driver to go back to a normal configuration.
3848 * @abort_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
3849 * when channel switch procedure was completed, allowing the
3850 * driver to go back to a normal configuration.
3851 * @channel_switch_rx_beacon: This is an optional callback that is called
3852 * when channel switch procedure is in progress and additional beacon with
3853 * CSA IE was received, allowing driver to track changes in count.
3854 * @join_ibss: Join an IBSS (on an IBSS interface); this is called after all
3855 * information in bss_conf is set up and the beacon can be retrieved. A
3856 * channel context is bound before this is called.
3857 * @leave_ibss: Leave the IBSS again.
3858 *
3859 * @get_expected_throughput: extract the expected throughput towards the
3860 * specified station. The returned value is expressed in Kbps. It returns 0
3861 * if the RC algorithm does not have proper data to provide.
3862 *
3863 * @get_txpower: get current maximum tx power (in dBm) based on configuration
3864 * and hardware limits.
3865 *
3866 * @tdls_channel_switch: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer. The driver
3867 * is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching operations
3868 * and returning to the base channel for communication with the AP. The
3869 * driver receives a channel-switch request template and the location of
3870 * the switch-timing IE within the template as part of the invocation.
3871 * The template is valid only within the call, and the driver can
3872 * optionally copy the skb for further re-use.
3873 * @tdls_cancel_channel_switch: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS peer. Both
3874 * peers must be on the base channel when the call completes.
3875 * @tdls_recv_channel_switch: a TDLS channel-switch related frame (request or
3876 * response) has been received from a remote peer. The driver gets
3877 * parameters parsed from the incoming frame and may use them to continue
3878 * an ongoing channel-switch operation. In addition, a channel-switch
3879 * response template is provided, together with the location of the
3880 * switch-timing IE within the template. The skb can only be used within
3881 * the function call.
3882 *
3883 * @wake_tx_queue: Called when new packets have been added to the queue.
3884 * @sync_rx_queues: Process all pending frames in RSS queues. This is a
3885 * synchronization which is needed in case driver has in its RSS queues
3886 * pending frames that were received prior to the control path action
3887 * currently taken (e.g. disassociation) but are not processed yet.
3888 *
3889 * @start_nan: join an existing NAN cluster, or create a new one.
3890 * @stop_nan: leave the NAN cluster.
3891 * @nan_change_conf: change NAN configuration. The data in cfg80211_nan_conf
3892 * contains full new configuration and changes specify which parameters
3893 * are changed with respect to the last NAN config.
3894 * The driver gets both full configuration and the changed parameters since
3895 * some devices may need the full configuration while others need only the
3896 * changed parameters.
3897 * @add_nan_func: Add a NAN function. Returns 0 on success. The data in
3898 * cfg80211_nan_func must not be referenced outside the scope of
3899 * this call.
3900 * @del_nan_func: Remove a NAN function. The driver must call
3901 * ieee80211_nan_func_terminated() with
3902 * NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_USER_REQUEST reason code upon removal.
3903 * @can_aggregate_in_amsdu: Called in order to determine if HW supports
3904 * aggregating two specific frames in the same A-MSDU. The relation
3905 * between the skbs should be symmetric and transitive. Note that while
3906 * skb is always a real frame, head may or may not be an A-MSDU.
3907 * @get_ftm_responder_stats: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, if available.
3908 * Statistics should be cumulative, currently no way to reset is provided.
3909 *
3910 * @start_pmsr: start peer measurement (e.g. FTM) (this call can sleep)
3911 * @abort_pmsr: abort peer measurement (this call can sleep)
3912 * @set_tid_config: Apply TID specific configurations. This callback may sleep.
3913 * @reset_tid_config: Reset TID specific configuration for the peer.
3914 * This callback may sleep.
3915 * @update_vif_offload: Update virtual interface offload flags
3916 * This callback may sleep.
3917 * @sta_set_4addr: Called to notify the driver when a station starts/stops using
3918 * 4-address mode
3919 * @set_sar_specs: Update the SAR (TX power) settings.
3920 * @sta_set_decap_offload: Called to notify the driver when a station is allowed
3921 * to use rx decapsulation offload
3922 */
3923 struct ieee80211_ops {
3924 void (*tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3925 struct ieee80211_tx_control *control,
3926 struct sk_buff *skb);
3927 int (*start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
3928 void (*stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
3929 #ifdef CONFIG_PM
3930 int (*suspend)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct cfg80211_wowlan *wowlan);
3931 int (*resume)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
3932 void (*set_wakeup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, bool enabled);
3933 #endif
3934 int (*add_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3935 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
3936 int (*change_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3937 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3938 enum nl80211_iftype new_type, bool p2p);
3939 void (*remove_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3940 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
3941 int (*config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 changed);
3942 void (*bss_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3943 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3944 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info,
3945 u32 changed);
3946
3947 int (*start_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
3948 void (*stop_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
3949
3950 u64 (*prepare_multicast)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3951 struct netdev_hw_addr_list *mc_list);
3952 void (*configure_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3953 unsigned int changed_flags,
3954 unsigned int *total_flags,
3955 u64 multicast);
3956 void (*config_iface_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3957 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3958 unsigned int filter_flags,
3959 unsigned int changed_flags);
3960 int (*set_tim)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
3961 bool set);
3962 int (*set_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, enum set_key_cmd cmd,
3963 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
3964 struct ieee80211_key_conf *key);
3965 void (*update_tkip_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3966 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3967 struct ieee80211_key_conf *conf,
3968 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
3969 u32 iv32, u16 *phase1key);
3970 void (*set_rekey_data)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3971 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3972 struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data *data);
3973 void (*set_default_unicast_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3974 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int idx);
3975 int (*hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3976 struct ieee80211_scan_request *req);
3977 void (*cancel_hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3978 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
3979 int (*sched_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3980 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3981 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *req,
3982 struct ieee80211_scan_ies *ies);
3983 int (*sched_scan_stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3984 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
3985 void (*sw_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3986 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3987 const u8 *mac_addr);
3988 void (*sw_scan_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3989 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
3990 int (*get_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3991 struct ieee80211_low_level_stats *stats);
3992 void (*get_key_seq)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3993 struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
3994 struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
3995 int (*set_frag_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 value);
3996 int (*set_rts_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 value);
3997 int (*sta_add)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3998 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
3999 int (*sta_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4000 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4001 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS
4002 void (*sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4003 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4004 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4005 struct dentry *dir);
4006 #endif
4007 void (*sta_notify)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4008 enum sta_notify_cmd, struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4009 int (*sta_set_txpwr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4010 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4011 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4012 int (*sta_state)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4013 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4014 enum ieee80211_sta_state old_state,
4015 enum ieee80211_sta_state new_state);
4016 void (*sta_pre_rcu_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4017 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4018 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4019 void (*sta_rc_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4020 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4021 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4022 u32 changed);
4023 void (*sta_rate_tbl_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4024 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4025 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4026 void (*sta_statistics)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4027 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4028 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4029 struct station_info *sinfo);
4030 int (*conf_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4031 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 ac,
4032 const struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params *params);
4033 u64 (*get_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4034 void (*set_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4035 u64 tsf);
4036 void (*offset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4037 s64 offset);
4038 void (*reset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4039 int (*tx_last_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4040
4041 /**
4042 * @ampdu_action:
4043 * Perform a certain A-MPDU action.
4044 * The RA/TID combination determines the destination and TID we want
4045 * the ampdu action to be performed for. The action is defined through
4046 * ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action.
4047 * When the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL the driver
4048 * may neither send aggregates containing more subframes than @buf_size
4049 * nor send aggregates in a way that lost frames would exceed the
4050 * buffer size. If just limiting the aggregate size, this would be
4051 * possible with a buf_size of 8:
4052 *
4053 * - ``TX: 1.....7``
4054 * - ``RX: 2....7`` (lost frame #1)
4055 * - ``TX: 8..1...``
4056 *
4057 * which is invalid since #1 was now re-transmitted well past the
4058 * buffer size of 8. Correct ways to retransmit #1 would be:
4059 *
4060 * - ``TX: 1 or``
4061 * - ``TX: 18 or``
4062 * - ``TX: 81``
4063 *
4064 * Even ``189`` would be wrong since 1 could be lost again.
4065 *
4066 * Returns a negative error code on failure. The driver may return
4067 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE for %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START
4068 * if the session can start immediately.
4069 *
4070 * The callback can sleep.
4071 */
4072 int (*ampdu_action)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4073 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4074 struct ieee80211_ampdu_params *params);
4075 int (*get_survey)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int idx,
4076 struct survey_info *survey);
4077 void (*rfkill_poll)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4078 void (*set_coverage_class)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, s16 coverage_class);
4079 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE
4080 int (*testmode_cmd)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4081 void *data, int len);
4082 int (*testmode_dump)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb,
4083 struct netlink_callback *cb,
4084 void *data, int len);
4085 #endif
4086 void (*flush)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4087 u32 queues, bool drop);
4088 void (*channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4089 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4090 struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4091 int (*set_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx_ant, u32 rx_ant);
4092 int (*get_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 *tx_ant, u32 *rx_ant);
4093
4094 int (*remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4095 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4096 struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
4097 int duration,
4098 enum ieee80211_roc_type type);
4099 int (*cancel_remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4100 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4101 int (*set_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx, u32 rx);
4102 void (*get_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4103 u32 *tx, u32 *tx_max, u32 *rx, u32 *rx_max);
4104 bool (*tx_frames_pending)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4105 int (*set_bitrate_mask)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4106 const struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask *mask);
4107 void (*event_callback)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4108 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4109 const struct ieee80211_event *event);
4110
4111 void (*allow_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4112 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4113 u16 tids, int num_frames,
4114 enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason,
4115 bool more_data);
4116 void (*release_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4117 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4118 u16 tids, int num_frames,
4119 enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason,
4120 bool more_data);
4121
4122 int (*get_et_sset_count)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4123 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int sset);
4124 void (*get_et_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4125 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4126 struct ethtool_stats *stats, u64 *data);
4127 void (*get_et_strings)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4128 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4129 u32 sset, u8 *data);
4130
4131 void (*mgd_prepare_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4132 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4133 struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info *info);
4134 void (*mgd_complete_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4135 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4136 struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info *info);
4137
4138 void (*mgd_protect_tdls_discover)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4139 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4140
4141 int (*add_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4142 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4143 void (*remove_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4144 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4145 void (*change_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4146 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx,
4147 u32 changed);
4148 int (*assign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4149 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4150 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4151 void (*unassign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4152 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4153 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4154 int (*switch_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4155 struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch *vifs,
4156 int n_vifs,
4157 enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode mode);
4158
4159 void (*reconfig_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4160 enum ieee80211_reconfig_type reconfig_type);
4161
4162 #if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_IPV6)
4163 void (*ipv6_addr_change)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4164 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4165 struct inet6_dev *idev);
4166 #endif
4167 void (*channel_switch_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4168 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4169 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4170 int (*pre_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4171 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4172 struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4173
4174 int (*post_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4175 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4176 void (*abort_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4177 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4178 void (*channel_switch_rx_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4179 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4180 struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4181
4182 int (*join_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4183 void (*leave_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4184 u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4185 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4186 int (*get_txpower)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4187 int *dbm);
4188
4189 int (*tdls_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4190 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4191 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 oper_class,
4192 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
4193 struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb, u32 ch_sw_tm_ie);
4194 void (*tdls_cancel_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4195 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4196 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4197 void (*tdls_recv_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4198 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4199 struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params *params);
4200
4201 void (*wake_tx_queue)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4202 struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
4203 void (*sync_rx_queues)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4204
4205 int (*start_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4206 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4207 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf);
4208 int (*stop_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4209 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4210 int (*nan_change_conf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4211 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4212 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf, u32 changes);
4213 int (*add_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4214 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4215 const struct cfg80211_nan_func *nan_func);
4216 void (*del_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4217 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4218 u8 instance_id);
4219 bool (*can_aggregate_in_amsdu)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4220 struct sk_buff *head,
4221 struct sk_buff *skb);
4222 int (*get_ftm_responder_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4223 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4224 struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats *ftm_stats);
4225 int (*start_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4226 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4227 void (*abort_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4228 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4229 int (*set_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4230 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4231 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4232 struct cfg80211_tid_config *tid_conf);
4233 int (*reset_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4234 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4235 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tids);
4236 void (*update_vif_offload)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4237 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4238 void (*sta_set_4addr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4239 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool enabled);
4240 int (*set_sar_specs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4241 const struct cfg80211_sar_specs *sar);
4242 void (*sta_set_decap_offload)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4243 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4244 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool enabled);
4245 };
4246
4247 /**
4248 * ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm - Allocate a new hardware device
4249 *
4250 * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer
4251 * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions.
4252 * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by
4253 * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as
4254 * @priv_data_len.
4255 *
4256 * @priv_data_len: length of private data
4257 * @ops: callbacks for this device
4258 * @requested_name: Requested name for this device.
4259 * NULL is valid value, and means use the default naming (phy%d)
4260 *
4261 * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error.
4262 */
4263 struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(size_t priv_data_len,
4264 const struct ieee80211_ops *ops,
4265 const char *requested_name);
4266
4267 /**
4268 * ieee80211_alloc_hw - Allocate a new hardware device
4269 *
4270 * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer
4271 * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions.
4272 * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by
4273 * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as
4274 * @priv_data_len.
4275 *
4276 * @priv_data_len: length of private data
4277 * @ops: callbacks for this device
4278 *
4279 * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error.
4280 */
4281 static inline
4282 struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw(size_t priv_data_len,
4283 const struct ieee80211_ops *ops)
4284 {
4285 return ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(priv_data_len, ops, NULL);
4286 }
4287
4288 /**
4289 * ieee80211_register_hw - Register hardware device
4290 *
4291 * You must call this function before any other functions in
4292 * mac80211. Note that before a hardware can be registered, you
4293 * need to fill the contained wiphy's information.
4294 *
4295 * @hw: the device to register as returned by ieee80211_alloc_hw()
4296 *
4297 * Return: 0 on success. An error code otherwise.
4298 */
4299 int ieee80211_register_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4300
4301 /**
4302 * struct ieee80211_tpt_blink - throughput blink description
4303 * @throughput: throughput in Kbit/sec
4304 * @blink_time: blink time in milliseconds
4305 * (full cycle, ie. one off + one on period)
4306 */
4307 struct ieee80211_tpt_blink {
4308 int throughput;
4309 int blink_time;
4310 };
4311
4312 /**
4313 * enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags - throughput trigger flags
4314 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO: enable blinking with radio
4315 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK: enable blinking when working
4316 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED: enable blinking when at least one
4317 * interface is connected in some way, including being an AP
4318 */
4319 enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags {
4320 IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO = BIT(0),
4321 IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK = BIT(1),
4322 IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED = BIT(2),
4323 };
4324
4325 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4326 const char *__ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4327 const char *__ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4328 const char *__ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4329 const char *__ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4330 const char *
4331 __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4332 unsigned int flags,
4333 const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table,
4334 unsigned int blink_table_len);
4335 #endif
4336 /**
4337 * ieee80211_get_tx_led_name - get name of TX LED
4338 *
4339 * mac80211 creates a transmit LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4340 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4341 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4342 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4343 *
4344 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4345 *
4346 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4347 */
4348 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4349 {
4350 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4351 return __ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(hw);
4352 #else
4353 return NULL;
4354 #endif
4355 }
4356
4357 /**
4358 * ieee80211_get_rx_led_name - get name of RX LED
4359 *
4360 * mac80211 creates a receive LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4361 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4362 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4363 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4364 *
4365 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4366 *
4367 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4368 */
4369 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4370 {
4371 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4372 return __ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(hw);
4373 #else
4374 return NULL;
4375 #endif
4376 }
4377
4378 /**
4379 * ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name - get name of association LED
4380 *
4381 * mac80211 creates a association LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4382 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4383 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4384 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4385 *
4386 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4387 *
4388 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4389 */
4390 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4391 {
4392 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4393 return __ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(hw);
4394 #else
4395 return NULL;
4396 #endif
4397 }
4398
4399 /**
4400 * ieee80211_get_radio_led_name - get name of radio LED
4401 *
4402 * mac80211 creates a radio change LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4403 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4404 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4405 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4406 *
4407 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4408 *
4409 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4410 */
4411 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4412 {
4413 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4414 return __ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(hw);
4415 #else
4416 return NULL;
4417 #endif
4418 }
4419
4420 /**
4421 * ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger - create throughput LED trigger
4422 * @hw: the hardware to create the trigger for
4423 * @flags: trigger flags, see &enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags
4424 * @blink_table: the blink table -- needs to be ordered by throughput
4425 * @blink_table_len: size of the blink table
4426 *
4427 * Return: %NULL (in case of error, or if no LED triggers are
4428 * configured) or the name of the new trigger.
4429 *
4430 * Note: This function must be called before ieee80211_register_hw().
4431 */
4432 static inline const char *
4433 ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, unsigned int flags,
4434 const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table,
4435 unsigned int blink_table_len)
4436 {
4437 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4438 return __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(hw, flags, blink_table,
4439 blink_table_len);
4440 #else
4441 return NULL;
4442 #endif
4443 }
4444
4445 /**
4446 * ieee80211_unregister_hw - Unregister a hardware device
4447 *
4448 * This function instructs mac80211 to free allocated resources
4449 * and unregister netdevices from the networking subsystem.
4450 *
4451 * @hw: the hardware to unregister
4452 */
4453 void ieee80211_unregister_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4454
4455 /**
4456 * ieee80211_free_hw - free hardware descriptor
4457 *
4458 * This function frees everything that was allocated, including the
4459 * private data for the driver. You must call ieee80211_unregister_hw()
4460 * before calling this function.
4461 *
4462 * @hw: the hardware to free
4463 */
4464 void ieee80211_free_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4465
4466 /**
4467 * ieee80211_restart_hw - restart hardware completely
4468 *
4469 * Call this function when the hardware was restarted for some reason
4470 * (hardware error, ...) and the driver is unable to restore its state
4471 * by itself. mac80211 assumes that at this point the driver/hardware
4472 * is completely uninitialised and stopped, it starts the process by
4473 * calling the ->start() operation. The driver will need to reset all
4474 * internal state that it has prior to calling this function.
4475 *
4476 * @hw: the hardware to restart
4477 */
4478 void ieee80211_restart_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4479
4480 /**
4481 * ieee80211_rx_list - receive frame and store processed skbs in a list
4482 *
4483 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
4484 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
4485 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
4486 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
4487 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
4488 *
4489 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
4490 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
4491 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
4492 * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4493 * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4494 *
4495 * This function must be called with BHs disabled and RCU read lock
4496 *
4497 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4498 * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL
4499 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4500 * @list: the destination list
4501 */
4502 void ieee80211_rx_list(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4503 struct sk_buff *skb, struct list_head *list);
4504
4505 /**
4506 * ieee80211_rx_napi - receive frame from NAPI context
4507 *
4508 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
4509 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
4510 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
4511 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
4512 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
4513 *
4514 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
4515 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
4516 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
4517 * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4518 * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4519 *
4520 * This function must be called with BHs disabled.
4521 *
4522 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4523 * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL
4524 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4525 * @napi: the NAPI context
4526 */
4527 void ieee80211_rx_napi(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4528 struct sk_buff *skb, struct napi_struct *napi);
4529
4530 /**
4531 * ieee80211_rx - receive frame
4532 *
4533 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
4534 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
4535 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
4536 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
4537 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
4538 *
4539 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
4540 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
4541 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
4542 * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4543 * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4544 *
4545 * In process context use instead ieee80211_rx_ni().
4546 *
4547 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4548 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4549 */
4550 static inline void ieee80211_rx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb)
4551 {
4552 ieee80211_rx_napi(hw, NULL, skb, NULL);
4553 }
4554
4555 /**
4556 * ieee80211_rx_irqsafe - receive frame
4557 *
4558 * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in IRQ context
4559 * (internally defers to a tasklet.)
4560 *
4561 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni() may not
4562 * be mixed for a single hardware.Must not run concurrently with
4563 * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4564 *
4565 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4566 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4567 */
4568 void ieee80211_rx_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);
4569
4570 /**
4571 * ieee80211_rx_ni - receive frame (in process context)
4572 *
4573 * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in process context
4574 * (internally disables bottom halves).
4575 *
4576 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may
4577 * not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4578 * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4579 *
4580 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4581 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4582 */
4583 static inline void ieee80211_rx_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4584 struct sk_buff *skb)
4585 {
4586 local_bh_disable();
4587 ieee80211_rx(hw, skb);
4588 local_bh_enable();
4589 }
4590
4591 /**
4592 * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition - PS transition for connected sta
4593 *
4594 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS
4595 * flag set, use this function to inform mac80211 about a connected station
4596 * entering/leaving PS mode.
4597 *
4598 * This function may not be called in IRQ context or with softirqs enabled.
4599 *
4600 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized against
4601 * each other.
4602 *
4603 * @sta: currently connected sta
4604 * @start: start or stop PS
4605 *
4606 * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL when the requested PS mode is already set.
4607 */
4608 int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool start);
4609
4610 /**
4611 * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni - PS transition for connected sta
4612 * (in process context)
4613 *
4614 * Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() but can be called in process context
4615 * (internally disables bottom halves). Concurrent call restriction still
4616 * applies.
4617 *
4618 * @sta: currently connected sta
4619 * @start: start or stop PS
4620 *
4621 * Return: Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition().
4622 */
4623 static inline int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4624 bool start)
4625 {
4626 int ret;
4627
4628 local_bh_disable();
4629 ret = ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(sta, start);
4630 local_bh_enable();
4631
4632 return ret;
4633 }
4634
4635 /**
4636 * ieee80211_sta_pspoll - PS-Poll frame received
4637 * @sta: currently connected station
4638 *
4639 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set,
4640 * use this function to inform mac80211 that a PS-Poll frame from a
4641 * connected station was received.
4642 * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition()
4643 * and possibly ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(); calls to all three must
4644 * be serialized.
4645 */
4646 void ieee80211_sta_pspoll(struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4647
4648 /**
4649 * ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger - (potential) U-APSD trigger frame received
4650 * @sta: currently connected station
4651 * @tid: TID of the received (potential) trigger frame
4652 *
4653 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set,
4654 * use this function to inform mac80211 that a (potential) trigger frame
4655 * from a connected station was received.
4656 * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition()
4657 * and possibly ieee80211_sta_pspoll(); calls to all three must be
4658 * serialized.
4659 * %IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS can be passed as the tid if the tid is unknown.
4660 * In this case, mac80211 will not check that this tid maps to an AC
4661 * that is trigger enabled and assume that the caller did the proper
4662 * checks.
4663 */
4664 void ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
4665
4666 /*
4667 * The TX headroom reserved by mac80211 for its own tx_status functions.
4668 * This is enough for the radiotap header.
4669 */
4670 #define IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_HEADROOM ALIGN(14, 4)
4671
4672 /**
4673 * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered - inform mac80211 about driver-buffered frames
4674 * @sta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer for the sleeping station
4675 * @tid: the TID that has buffered frames
4676 * @buffered: indicates whether or not frames are buffered for this TID
4677 *
4678 * If a driver buffers frames for a powersave station instead of passing
4679 * them back to mac80211 for retransmission, the station may still need
4680 * to be told that there are buffered frames via the TIM bit.
4681 *
4682 * This function informs mac80211 whether or not there are frames that are
4683 * buffered in the driver for a given TID; mac80211 can then use this data
4684 * to set the TIM bit (NOTE: This may call back into the driver's set_tim
4685 * call! Beware of the locking!)
4686 *
4687 * If all frames are released to the station (due to PS-poll or uAPSD)
4688 * then the driver needs to inform mac80211 that there no longer are
4689 * frames buffered. However, when the station wakes up mac80211 assumes
4690 * that all buffered frames will be transmitted and clears this data,
4691 * drivers need to make sure they inform mac80211 about all buffered
4692 * frames on the sleep transition (sta_notify() with %STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP).
4693 *
4694 * Note that technically mac80211 only needs to know this per AC, not per
4695 * TID, but since driver buffering will inevitably happen per TID (since
4696 * it is related to aggregation) it is easier to make mac80211 map the
4697 * TID to the AC as required instead of keeping track in all drivers that
4698 * use this API.
4699 */
4700 void ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4701 u8 tid, bool buffered);
4702
4703 /**
4704 * ieee80211_get_tx_rates - get the selected transmit rates for a packet
4705 *
4706 * Call this function in a driver with per-packet rate selection support
4707 * to combine the rate info in the packet tx info with the most recent
4708 * rate selection table for the station entry.
4709 *
4710 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
4711 * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent.
4712 * @skb: the frame to be transmitted.
4713 * @dest: buffer for extracted rate/retry information
4714 * @max_rates: maximum number of rates to fetch
4715 */
4716 void ieee80211_get_tx_rates(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4717 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4718 struct sk_buff *skb,
4719 struct ieee80211_tx_rate *dest,
4720 int max_rates);
4721
4722 /**
4723 * ieee80211_sta_set_expected_throughput - set the expected tpt for a station
4724 *
4725 * Call this function to notify mac80211 about a change in expected throughput
4726 * to a station. A driver for a device that does rate control in firmware can
4727 * call this function when the expected throughput estimate towards a station
4728 * changes. The information is used to tune the CoDel AQM applied to traffic
4729 * going towards that station (which can otherwise be too aggressive and cause
4730 * slow stations to starve).
4731 *
4732 * @pubsta: the station to set throughput for.
4733 * @thr: the current expected throughput in kbps.
4734 */
4735 void ieee80211_sta_set_expected_throughput(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
4736 u32 thr);
4737
4738 /**
4739 * ieee80211_tx_rate_update - transmit rate update callback
4740 *
4741 * Drivers should call this functions with a non-NULL pub sta
4742 * This function can be used in drivers that does not have provision
4743 * in updating the tx rate in data path.
4744 *
4745 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
4746 * @pubsta: the station to update the tx rate for.
4747 * @info: tx status information
4748 */
4749 void ieee80211_tx_rate_update(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4750 struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
4751 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info);
4752
4753 /**
4754 * ieee80211_tx_status - transmit status callback
4755 *
4756 * Call this function for all transmitted frames after they have been
4757 * transmitted. It is permissible to not call this function for
4758 * multicast frames but this can affect statistics.
4759 *
4760 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
4761 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls
4762 * to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni() and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe()
4763 * may not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4764 * ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni().
4765 *
4766 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
4767 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
4768 */
4769 void ieee80211_tx_status(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4770 struct sk_buff *skb);
4771
4772 /**
4773 * ieee80211_tx_status_ext - extended transmit status callback
4774 *
4775 * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status
4776 * in drivers that may want to provide extra information that does not
4777 * fit into &struct ieee80211_tx_info.
4778 *
4779 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized
4780 * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni()
4781 * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
4782 *
4783 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
4784 * @status: tx status information
4785 */
4786 void ieee80211_tx_status_ext(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4787 struct ieee80211_tx_status *status);
4788
4789 /**
4790 * ieee80211_tx_status_noskb - transmit status callback without skb
4791 *
4792 * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status
4793 * in drivers that cannot reliably map tx status information back to
4794 * specific skbs.
4795 *
4796 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized
4797 * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni()
4798 * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
4799 *
4800 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
4801 * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent
4802 * (NULL for multicast packets)
4803 * @info: tx status information
4804 */
4805 static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_noskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4806 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4807 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
4808 {
4809 struct ieee80211_tx_status status = {
4810 .sta = sta,
4811 .info = info,
4812 };
4813
4814 ieee80211_tx_status_ext(hw, &status);
4815 }
4816
4817 /**
4818 * ieee80211_tx_status_ni - transmit status callback (in process context)
4819 *
4820 * Like ieee80211_tx_status() but can be called in process context.
4821 *
4822 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status() and
4823 * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed
4824 * for a single hardware.
4825 *
4826 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
4827 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
4828 */
4829 static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4830 struct sk_buff *skb)
4831 {
4832 local_bh_disable();
4833 ieee80211_tx_status(hw, skb);
4834 local_bh_enable();
4835 }
4836
4837 /**
4838 * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe - IRQ-safe transmit status callback
4839 *
4840 * Like ieee80211_tx_status() but can be called in IRQ context
4841 * (internally defers to a tasklet.)
4842 *
4843 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status() and
4844 * ieee80211_tx_status_ni() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
4845 *
4846 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
4847 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
4848 */
4849 void ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4850 struct sk_buff *skb);
4851
4852 /**
4853 * ieee80211_tx_status_8023 - transmit status callback for 802.3 frame format
4854 *
4855 * Call this function for all transmitted data frames after their transmit
4856 * completion. This callback should only be called for data frames which
4857 * are using driver's (or hardware's) offload capability of encap/decap
4858 * 802.11 frames.
4859 *
4860 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
4861 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other and all
4862 * calls in the same tx status family.
4863 *
4864 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
4865 * @vif: the interface for which the frame was transmitted
4866 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
4867 */
4868 void ieee80211_tx_status_8023(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4869 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4870 struct sk_buff *skb);
4871
4872 /**
4873 * ieee80211_report_low_ack - report non-responding station
4874 *
4875 * When operating in AP-mode, call this function to report a non-responding
4876 * connected STA.
4877 *
4878 * @sta: the non-responding connected sta
4879 * @num_packets: number of packets sent to @sta without a response
4880 */
4881 void ieee80211_report_low_ack(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u32 num_packets);
4882
4883 #define IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM 2
4884
4885 /**
4886 * struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets - mutable beacon offsets
4887 * @tim_offset: position of TIM element
4888 * @tim_length: size of TIM element
4889 * @cntdwn_counter_offs: array of IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM offsets
4890 * to countdown counters. This array can contain zero values which
4891 * should be ignored.
4892 */
4893 struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets {
4894 u16 tim_offset;
4895 u16 tim_length;
4896
4897 u16 cntdwn_counter_offs[IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM];
4898 };
4899
4900 /**
4901 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template - beacon template generation function
4902 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
4903 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
4904 * @offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
4905 * receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
4906 *
4907 * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to
4908 * obtain the beacon template.
4909 *
4910 * This function should be used if the beacon frames are generated by the
4911 * device, and then the driver must use the returned beacon as the template
4912 * The driver or the device are responsible to update the DTIM and, when
4913 * applicable, the CSA count.
4914 *
4915 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
4916 *
4917 * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error.
4918 */
4919 struct sk_buff *
4920 ieee80211_beacon_get_template(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4921 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4922 struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets *offs);
4923
4924 /**
4925 * ieee80211_beacon_get_tim - beacon generation function
4926 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
4927 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
4928 * @tim_offset: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE offset.
4929 * Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes).
4930 * @tim_length: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE length,
4931 * (including the ID and length bytes!).
4932 * Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes).
4933 *
4934 * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to
4935 * obtain the beacon frame.
4936 *
4937 * If the beacon frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
4938 * hardware/firmware), the driver uses this function to get each beacon
4939 * frame from mac80211 -- it is responsible for calling this function exactly
4940 * once before the beacon is needed (e.g. based on hardware interrupt).
4941 *
4942 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
4943 *
4944 * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error.
4945 */
4946 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4947 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4948 u16 *tim_offset, u16 *tim_length);
4949
4950 /**
4951 * ieee80211_beacon_get - beacon generation function
4952 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
4953 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
4954 *
4955 * See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim().
4956 *
4957 * Return: See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim().
4958 */
4959 static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4960 struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
4961 {
4962 return ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(hw, vif, NULL, NULL);
4963 }
4964
4965 /**
4966 * ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn - request mac80211 to decrement the beacon countdown
4967 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
4968 *
4969 * The beacon counter should be updated after each beacon transmission.
4970 * This function is called implicitly when
4971 * ieee80211_beacon_get/ieee80211_beacon_get_tim are called, however if the
4972 * beacon frames are generated by the device, the driver should call this
4973 * function after each beacon transmission to sync mac80211's beacon countdown.
4974 *
4975 * Return: new countdown value
4976 */
4977 u8 ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4978
4979 /**
4980 * ieee80211_beacon_set_cntdwn - request mac80211 to set beacon countdown
4981 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
4982 * @counter: the new value for the counter
4983 *
4984 * The beacon countdown can be changed by the device, this API should be
4985 * used by the device driver to update csa counter in mac80211.
4986 *
4987 * It should never be used together with ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn(),
4988 * as it will cause a race condition around the counter value.
4989 */
4990 void ieee80211_beacon_set_cntdwn(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 counter);
4991
4992 /**
4993 * ieee80211_csa_finish - notify mac80211 about channel switch
4994 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
4995 *
4996 * After a channel switch announcement was scheduled and the counter in this
4997 * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to
4998 * notify mac80211 that the channel can be changed.
4999 */
5000 void ieee80211_csa_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5001
5002 /**
5003 * ieee80211_beacon_cntdwn_is_complete - find out if countdown reached 1
5004 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5005 *
5006 * This function returns whether the countdown reached zero.
5007 */
5008 bool ieee80211_beacon_cntdwn_is_complete(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5009
5010 /**
5011 * ieee80211_proberesp_get - retrieve a Probe Response template
5012 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5013 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5014 *
5015 * Creates a Probe Response template which can, for example, be uploaded to
5016 * hardware. The destination address should be set by the caller.
5017 *
5018 * Can only be called in AP mode.
5019 *
5020 * Return: The Probe Response template. %NULL on error.
5021 */
5022 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_proberesp_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5023 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5024
5025 /**
5026 * ieee80211_pspoll_get - retrieve a PS Poll template
5027 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5028 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5029 *
5030 * Creates a PS Poll a template which can, for example, uploaded to
5031 * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct
5032 * AID, BSSID and MAC address is used.
5033 *
5034 * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the
5035 * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit.
5036 *
5037 * Return: The PS Poll template. %NULL on error.
5038 */
5039 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_pspoll_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5040 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5041
5042 /**
5043 * ieee80211_nullfunc_get - retrieve a nullfunc template
5044 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5045 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5046 * @qos_ok: QoS NDP is acceptable to the caller, this should be set
5047 * if at all possible
5048 *
5049 * Creates a Nullfunc template which can, for example, uploaded to
5050 * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct
5051 * BSSID and address is used.
5052 *
5053 * If @qos_ndp is set and the association is to an AP with QoS/WMM, the
5054 * returned packet will be QoS NDP.
5055 *
5056 * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the
5057 * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit as well as Duration and Sequence Control fields.
5058 *
5059 * Return: The nullfunc template. %NULL on error.
5060 */
5061 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_nullfunc_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5062 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5063 bool qos_ok);
5064
5065 /**
5066 * ieee80211_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template
5067 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5068 * @src_addr: source MAC address
5069 * @ssid: SSID buffer
5070 * @ssid_len: length of SSID
5071 * @tailroom: tailroom to reserve at end of SKB for IEs
5072 *
5073 * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to
5074 * hardware.
5075 *
5076 * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error.
5077 */
5078 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5079 const u8 *src_addr,
5080 const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len,
5081 size_t tailroom);
5082
5083 /**
5084 * ieee80211_rts_get - RTS frame generation function
5085 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5086 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5087 * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS.
5088 * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets).
5089 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5090 * @rts: The buffer where to store the RTS frame.
5091 *
5092 * If the RTS frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5093 * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5094 * the next RTS frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible
5095 * for calling this function before and RTS frame is needed.
5096 */
5097 void ieee80211_rts_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5098 const void *frame, size_t frame_len,
5099 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl,
5100 struct ieee80211_rts *rts);
5101
5102 /**
5103 * ieee80211_rts_duration - Get the duration field for an RTS frame
5104 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5105 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5106 * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS.
5107 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5108 *
5109 * If the RTS is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide
5110 * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5111 * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder.
5112 *
5113 * Return: The duration.
5114 */
5115 __le16 ieee80211_rts_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5116 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, size_t frame_len,
5117 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl);
5118
5119 /**
5120 * ieee80211_ctstoself_get - CTS-to-self frame generation function
5121 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5122 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5123 * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self.
5124 * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets).
5125 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5126 * @cts: The buffer where to store the CTS-to-self frame.
5127 *
5128 * If the CTS-to-self frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5129 * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5130 * the next CTS-to-self frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible
5131 * for calling this function before and CTS-to-self frame is needed.
5132 */
5133 void ieee80211_ctstoself_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5134 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5135 const void *frame, size_t frame_len,
5136 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl,
5137 struct ieee80211_cts *cts);
5138
5139 /**
5140 * ieee80211_ctstoself_duration - Get the duration field for a CTS-to-self frame
5141 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5142 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5143 * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self.
5144 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5145 *
5146 * If the CTS-to-self is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide
5147 * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5148 * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder.
5149 *
5150 * Return: The duration.
5151 */
5152 __le16 ieee80211_ctstoself_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5153 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5154 size_t frame_len,
5155 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl);
5156
5157 /**
5158 * ieee80211_generic_frame_duration - Calculate the duration field for a frame
5159 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5160 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5161 * @band: the band to calculate the frame duration on
5162 * @frame_len: the length of the frame.
5163 * @rate: the rate at which the frame is going to be transmitted.
5164 *
5165 * Calculate the duration field of some generic frame, given its
5166 * length and transmission rate (in 100kbps).
5167 *
5168 * Return: The duration.
5169 */
5170 __le16 ieee80211_generic_frame_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5171 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5172 enum nl80211_band band,
5173 size_t frame_len,
5174 struct ieee80211_rate *rate);
5175
5176 /**
5177 * ieee80211_get_buffered_bc - accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames
5178 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5179 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5180 *
5181 * Function for accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames. If
5182 * hardware/firmware does not implement buffering of broadcast/multicast
5183 * frames when power saving is used, 802.11 code buffers them in the host
5184 * memory. The low-level driver uses this function to fetch next buffered
5185 * frame. In most cases, this is used when generating beacon frame.
5186 *
5187 * Return: A pointer to the next buffered skb or NULL if no more buffered
5188 * frames are available.
5189 *
5190 * Note: buffered frames are returned only after DTIM beacon frame was
5191 * generated with ieee80211_beacon_get() and the low-level driver must thus
5192 * call ieee80211_beacon_get() first. ieee80211_get_buffered_bc() returns
5193 * NULL if the previous generated beacon was not DTIM, so the low-level driver
5194 * does not need to check for DTIM beacons separately and should be able to
5195 * use common code for all beacons.
5196 */
5197 struct sk_buff *
5198 ieee80211_get_buffered_bc(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5199
5200 /**
5201 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv - get a TKIP phase 1 key for IV32
5202 *
5203 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32.
5204 *
5205 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5206 * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for
5207 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5208 */
5209 void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5210 u32 iv32, u16 *p1k);
5211
5212 /**
5213 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key
5214 *
5215 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the IV32 taken
5216 * from the given packet.
5217 *
5218 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5219 * @skb: the packet to take the IV32 value from that will be encrypted
5220 * with this P1K
5221 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5222 */
5223 static inline void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5224 struct sk_buff *skb, u16 *p1k)
5225 {
5226 struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (struct ieee80211_hdr *)skb->data;
5227 const u8 *data = (u8 *)hdr + ieee80211_hdrlen(hdr->frame_control);
5228 u32 iv32 = get_unaligned_le32(&data[4]);
5229
5230 ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(keyconf, iv32, p1k);
5231 }
5232
5233 /**
5234 * ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key for RX
5235 *
5236 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32
5237 * and transmitter address.
5238 *
5239 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5240 * @ta: TA that will be used with the key
5241 * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for
5242 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5243 */
5244 void ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5245 const u8 *ta, u32 iv32, u16 *p1k);
5246
5247 /**
5248 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k - get a TKIP phase 2 key
5249 *
5250 * This function computes the TKIP RC4 key for the IV values
5251 * in the packet.
5252 *
5253 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5254 * @skb: the packet to take the IV32/IV16 values from that will be
5255 * encrypted with this key
5256 * @p2k: a buffer to which the key will be written, 16 bytes
5257 */
5258 void ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5259 struct sk_buff *skb, u8 *p2k);
5260
5261 /**
5262 * ieee80211_tkip_add_iv - write TKIP IV and Ext. IV to pos
5263 *
5264 * @pos: start of crypto header
5265 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5266 * @pn: PN to add
5267 *
5268 * Returns: pointer to the octet following IVs (i.e. beginning of
5269 * the packet payload)
5270 *
5271 * This function writes the tkip IV value to pos (which should
5272 * point to the crypto header)
5273 */
5274 u8 *ieee80211_tkip_add_iv(u8 *pos, struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, u64 pn);
5275
5276 /**
5277 * ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq - get key RX sequence counter
5278 *
5279 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5280 * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only);
5281 * the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For
5282 * CMAC, only TID 0 is valid.
5283 * @seq: buffer to receive the sequence data
5284 *
5285 * This function allows a driver to retrieve the current RX IV/PNs
5286 * for the given key. It must not be called if IV checking is done
5287 * by the device and not by mac80211.
5288 *
5289 * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing
5290 * can be done concurrently.
5291 */
5292 void ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5293 int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
5294
5295 /**
5296 * ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq - set key RX sequence counter
5297 *
5298 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5299 * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only);
5300 * the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For
5301 * CMAC, only TID 0 is valid.
5302 * @seq: new sequence data
5303 *
5304 * This function allows a driver to set the current RX IV/PNs for the
5305 * given key. This is useful when resuming from WoWLAN sleep and GTK
5306 * rekey may have been done while suspended. It should not be called
5307 * if IV checking is done by the device and not by mac80211.
5308 *
5309 * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing
5310 * can be done concurrently.
5311 */
5312 void ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5313 int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
5314
5315 /**
5316 * ieee80211_remove_key - remove the given key
5317 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5318 *
5319 * Remove the given key. If the key was uploaded to the hardware at the
5320 * time this function is called, it is not deleted in the hardware but
5321 * instead assumed to have been removed already.
5322 *
5323 * Note that due to locking considerations this function can (currently)
5324 * only be called during key iteration (ieee80211_iter_keys().)
5325 */
5326 void ieee80211_remove_key(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
5327
5328 /**
5329 * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add - add a GTK key from rekeying during WoWLAN
5330 * @vif: the virtual interface to add the key on
5331 * @keyconf: new key data
5332 *
5333 * When GTK rekeying was done while the system was suspended, (a) new
5334 * key(s) will be available. These will be needed by mac80211 for proper
5335 * RX processing, so this function allows setting them.
5336 *
5337 * The function returns the newly allocated key structure, which will
5338 * have similar contents to the passed key configuration but point to
5339 * mac80211-owned memory. In case of errors, the function returns an
5340 * ERR_PTR(), use IS_ERR() etc.
5341 *
5342 * Note that this function assumes the key isn't added to hardware
5343 * acceleration, so no TX will be done with the key. Since it's a GTK
5344 * on managed (station) networks, this is true anyway. If the driver
5345 * calls this function from the resume callback and subsequently uses
5346 * the return code 1 to reconfigure the device, this key will be part
5347 * of the reconfiguration.
5348 *
5349 * Note that the driver should also call ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq()
5350 * for the new key for each TID to set up sequence counters properly.
5351 *
5352 * IMPORTANT: If this replaces a key that is present in the hardware,
5353 * then it will attempt to remove it during this call. In many cases
5354 * this isn't what you want, so call ieee80211_remove_key() first for
5355 * the key that's being replaced.
5356 */
5357 struct ieee80211_key_conf *
5358 ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5359 struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
5360
5361 /**
5362 * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify - notify userspace supplicant of rekeying
5363 * @vif: virtual interface the rekeying was done on
5364 * @bssid: The BSSID of the AP, for checking association
5365 * @replay_ctr: the new replay counter after GTK rekeying
5366 * @gfp: allocation flags
5367 */
5368 void ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *bssid,
5369 const u8 *replay_ctr, gfp_t gfp);
5370
5371 /**
5372 * ieee80211_key_mic_failure - increment MIC failure counter for the key
5373 *
5374 * Note: this is really only safe if no other RX function is called
5375 * at the same time.
5376 *
5377 * @keyconf: the key in question
5378 */
5379 void ieee80211_key_mic_failure(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
5380
5381 /**
5382 * ieee80211_key_replay - increment replay counter for the key
5383 *
5384 * Note: this is really only safe if no other RX function is called
5385 * at the same time.
5386 *
5387 * @keyconf: the key in question
5388 */
5389 void ieee80211_key_replay(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
5390
5391 /**
5392 * ieee80211_wake_queue - wake specific queue
5393 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5394 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
5395 *
5396 * Drivers should use this function instead of netif_wake_queue.
5397 */
5398 void ieee80211_wake_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
5399
5400 /**
5401 * ieee80211_stop_queue - stop specific queue
5402 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5403 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
5404 *
5405 * Drivers should use this function instead of netif_stop_queue.
5406 */
5407 void ieee80211_stop_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
5408
5409 /**
5410 * ieee80211_queue_stopped - test status of the queue
5411 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5412 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
5413 *
5414 * Drivers should use this function instead of netif_stop_queue.
5415 *
5416 * Return: %true if the queue is stopped. %false otherwise.
5417 */
5418
5419 int ieee80211_queue_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
5420
5421 /**
5422 * ieee80211_stop_queues - stop all queues
5423 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5424 *
5425 * Drivers should use this function instead of netif_stop_queue.
5426 */
5427 void ieee80211_stop_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5428
5429 /**
5430 * ieee80211_wake_queues - wake all queues
5431 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5432 *
5433 * Drivers should use this function instead of netif_wake_queue.
5434 */
5435 void ieee80211_wake_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5436
5437 /**
5438 * ieee80211_scan_completed - completed hardware scan
5439 *
5440 * When hardware scan offload is used (i.e. the hw_scan() callback is
5441 * assigned) this function needs to be called by the driver to notify
5442 * mac80211 that the scan finished. This function can be called from
5443 * any context, including hardirq context.
5444 *
5445 * @hw: the hardware that finished the scan
5446 * @info: information about the completed scan
5447 */
5448 void ieee80211_scan_completed(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5449 struct cfg80211_scan_info *info);
5450
5451 /**
5452 * ieee80211_sched_scan_results - got results from scheduled scan
5453 *
5454 * When a scheduled scan is running, this function needs to be called by the
5455 * driver whenever there are new scan results available.
5456 *
5457 * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans
5458 */
5459 void ieee80211_sched_scan_results(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5460
5461 /**
5462 * ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped - inform that the scheduled scan has stopped
5463 *
5464 * When a scheduled scan is running, this function can be called by
5465 * the driver if it needs to stop the scan to perform another task.
5466 * Usual scenarios are drivers that cannot continue the scheduled scan
5467 * while associating, for instance.
5468 *
5469 * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans
5470 */
5471 void ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5472
5473 /**
5474 * enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags - interface iteration flags
5475 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL: Iterate over all interfaces that have
5476 * been added to the driver; However, note that during hardware
5477 * reconfiguration (after restart_hw) it will iterate over a new
5478 * interface and over all the existing interfaces even if they
5479 * haven't been re-added to the driver yet.
5480 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL: During resume, iterate over all
5481 * interfaces, even if they haven't been re-added to the driver yet.
5482 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE: Iterate only active interfaces (netdev is up).
5483 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_SKIP_SDATA_NOT_IN_DRIVER: Skip any interfaces where SDATA
5484 * is not in the driver. This may fix crashes during firmware recovery
5485 * for instance.
5486 */
5487 enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags {
5488 IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL = 0,
5489 IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL = BIT(0),
5490 IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE = BIT(1),
5491 IEEE80211_IFACE_SKIP_SDATA_NOT_IN_DRIVER = BIT(2),
5492 };
5493
5494 /**
5495 * ieee80211_iterate_interfaces - iterate interfaces
5496 *
5497 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
5498 * hardware and calls the callback for them. This includes active as well as
5499 * inactive interfaces. This function allows the iterator function to sleep.
5500 * Will iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
5501 *
5502 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
5503 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
5504 * @iterator: the iterator function to call
5505 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
5506 */
5507 void ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags,
5508 void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
5509 struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
5510 void *data);
5511
5512 /**
5513 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces - iterate active interfaces
5514 *
5515 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
5516 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
5517 * This function allows the iterator function to sleep, when the iterator
5518 * function is atomic @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic can
5519 * be used.
5520 * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
5521 *
5522 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
5523 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
5524 * @iterator: the iterator function to call
5525 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
5526 */
5527 static inline void
5528 ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags,
5529 void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
5530 struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
5531 void *data)
5532 {
5533 ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(hw,
5534 iter_flags | IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE,
5535 iterator, data);
5536 }
5537
5538 /**
5539 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic - iterate active interfaces
5540 *
5541 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
5542 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
5543 * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic,
5544 * if that is not desired, use @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces instead.
5545 * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
5546 *
5547 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
5548 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
5549 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
5550 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
5551 */
5552 void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5553 u32 iter_flags,
5554 void (*iterator)(void *data,
5555 u8 *mac,
5556 struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
5557 void *data);
5558
5559 /**
5560 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx - iterate active interfaces
5561 *
5562 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
5563 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
5564 * This version can only be used while holding the wiphy mutex.
5565 *
5566 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
5567 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
5568 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
5569 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
5570 */
5571 void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5572 u32 iter_flags,
5573 void (*iterator)(void *data,
5574 u8 *mac,
5575 struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
5576 void *data);
5577
5578 /**
5579 * ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic - iterate stations
5580 *
5581 * This function iterates over all stations associated with a given
5582 * hardware that are currently uploaded to the driver and calls the callback
5583 * function for them.
5584 * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic,
5585 *
5586 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
5587 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
5588 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
5589 */
5590 void ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5591 void (*iterator)(void *data,
5592 struct ieee80211_sta *sta),
5593 void *data);
5594 /**
5595 * ieee80211_queue_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue
5596 *
5597 * Drivers and mac80211 use this to add work onto the mac80211 workqueue.
5598 * This helper ensures drivers are not queueing work when they should not be.
5599 *
5600 * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for
5601 * @work: the work we want to add onto the mac80211 workqueue
5602 */
5603 void ieee80211_queue_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct work_struct *work);
5604
5605 /**
5606 * ieee80211_queue_delayed_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue
5607 *
5608 * Drivers and mac80211 use this to queue delayed work onto the mac80211
5609 * workqueue.
5610 *
5611 * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for
5612 * @dwork: delayable work to queue onto the mac80211 workqueue
5613 * @delay: number of jiffies to wait before queueing
5614 */
5615 void ieee80211_queue_delayed_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5616 struct delayed_work *dwork,
5617 unsigned long delay);
5618
5619 /**
5620 * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session - Start a tx Block Ack session.
5621 * @sta: the station for which to start a BA session
5622 * @tid: the TID to BA on.
5623 * @timeout: session timeout value (in TUs)
5624 *
5625 * Return: success if addBA request was sent, failure otherwise
5626 *
5627 * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate
5628 * the need to start aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level
5629 * will be managed by the mac80211.
5630 */
5631 int ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid,
5632 u16 timeout);
5633
5634 /**
5635 * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to aggregate.
5636 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
5637 * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient.
5638 * @tid: the TID to BA on.
5639 *
5640 * This function must be called by low level driver once it has
5641 * finished with preparations for the BA session. It can be called
5642 * from any context.
5643 */
5644 void ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra,
5645 u16 tid);
5646
5647 /**
5648 * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session - Stop a Block Ack session.
5649 * @sta: the station whose BA session to stop
5650 * @tid: the TID to stop BA.
5651 *
5652 * Return: negative error if the TID is invalid, or no aggregation active
5653 *
5654 * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate
5655 * the need to stop aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level
5656 * will be managed by the mac80211.
5657 */
5658 int ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid);
5659
5660 /**
5661 * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to stop aggregate.
5662 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
5663 * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient.
5664 * @tid: the desired TID to BA on.
5665 *
5666 * This function must be called by low level driver once it has
5667 * finished with preparations for the BA session tear down. It
5668 * can be called from any context.
5669 */
5670 void ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra,
5671 u16 tid);
5672
5673 /**
5674 * ieee80211_find_sta - find a station
5675 *
5676 * @vif: virtual interface to look for station on
5677 * @addr: station's address
5678 *
5679 * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise.
5680 *
5681 * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the
5682 * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well.
5683 */
5684 struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5685 const u8 *addr);
5686
5687 /**
5688 * ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr - find a station on hardware
5689 *
5690 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
5691 * @addr: remote station's address
5692 * @localaddr: local address (vif->sdata->vif.addr). Use NULL for 'any'.
5693 *
5694 * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise.
5695 *
5696 * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the
5697 * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well.
5698 *
5699 * NOTE: You may pass NULL for localaddr, but then you will just get
5700 * the first STA that matches the remote address 'addr'.
5701 * We can have multiple STA associated with multiple
5702 * logical stations (e.g. consider a station connecting to another
5703 * BSSID on the same AP hardware without disconnecting first).
5704 * In this case, the result of this method with localaddr NULL
5705 * is not reliable.
5706 *
5707 * DO NOT USE THIS FUNCTION with localaddr NULL if at all possible.
5708 */
5709 struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5710 const u8 *addr,
5711 const u8 *localaddr);
5712
5713 /**
5714 * ieee80211_sta_block_awake - block station from waking up
5715 * @hw: the hardware
5716 * @pubsta: the station
5717 * @block: whether to block or unblock
5718 *
5719 * Some devices require that all frames that are on the queues
5720 * for a specific station that went to sleep are flushed before
5721 * a poll response or frames after the station woke up can be
5722 * delivered to that it. Note that such frames must be rejected
5723 * by the driver as filtered, with the appropriate status flag.
5724 *
5725 * This function allows implementing this mode in a race-free
5726 * manner.
5727 *
5728 * To do this, a driver must keep track of the number of frames
5729 * still enqueued for a specific station. If this number is not
5730 * zero when the station goes to sleep, the driver must call
5731 * this function to force mac80211 to consider the station to
5732 * be asleep regardless of the station's actual state. Once the
5733 * number of outstanding frames reaches zero, the driver must
5734 * call this function again to unblock the station. That will
5735 * cause mac80211 to be able to send ps-poll responses, and if
5736 * the station queried in the meantime then frames will also
5737 * be sent out as a result of this. Additionally, the driver
5738 * will be notified that the station woke up some time after
5739 * it is unblocked, regardless of whether the station actually
5740 * woke up while blocked or not.
5741 */
5742 void ieee80211_sta_block_awake(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5743 struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, bool block);
5744
5745 /**
5746 * ieee80211_sta_eosp - notify mac80211 about end of SP
5747 * @pubsta: the station
5748 *
5749 * When a device transmits frames in a way that it can't tell
5750 * mac80211 in the TX status about the EOSP, it must clear the
5751 * %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP bit and call this function instead.
5752 * This applies for PS-Poll as well as uAPSD.
5753 *
5754 * Note that just like with _tx_status() and _rx() drivers must
5755 * not mix calls to irqsafe/non-irqsafe versions, this function
5756 * must not be mixed with those either. Use the all irqsafe, or
5757 * all non-irqsafe, don't mix!
5758 *
5759 * NB: the _irqsafe version of this function doesn't exist, no
5760 * driver needs it right now. Don't call this function if
5761 * you'd need the _irqsafe version, look at the git history
5762 * and restore the _irqsafe version!
5763 */
5764 void ieee80211_sta_eosp(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
5765
5766 /**
5767 * ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc - ask mac80211 to send NDP with EOSP
5768 * @pubsta: the station
5769 * @tid: the tid of the NDP
5770 *
5771 * Sometimes the device understands that it needs to close
5772 * the Service Period unexpectedly. This can happen when
5773 * sending frames that are filling holes in the BA window.
5774 * In this case, the device can ask mac80211 to send a
5775 * Nullfunc frame with EOSP set. When that happens, the
5776 * driver must have called ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() to
5777 * let mac80211 know that there are no buffered frames any
5778 * more, otherwise mac80211 will get the more_data bit wrong.
5779 * The low level driver must have made sure that the frame
5780 * will be sent despite the station being in power-save.
5781 * Mac80211 won't call allow_buffered_frames().
5782 * Note that calling this function, doesn't exempt the driver
5783 * from closing the EOSP properly, it will still have to call
5784 * ieee80211_sta_eosp when the NDP is sent.
5785 */
5786 void ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, int tid);
5787
5788 /**
5789 * ieee80211_sta_register_airtime - register airtime usage for a sta/tid
5790 *
5791 * Register airtime usage for a given sta on a given tid. The driver must call
5792 * this function to notify mac80211 that a station used a certain amount of
5793 * airtime. This information will be used by the TXQ scheduler to schedule
5794 * stations in a way that ensures airtime fairness.
5795 *
5796 * The reported airtime should as a minimum include all time that is spent
5797 * transmitting to the remote station, including overhead and padding, but not
5798 * including time spent waiting for a TXOP. If the time is not reported by the
5799 * hardware it can in some cases be calculated from the rate and known frame
5800 * composition. When possible, the time should include any failed transmission
5801 * attempts.
5802 *
5803 * The driver can either call this function synchronously for every packet or
5804 * aggregate, or asynchronously as airtime usage information becomes available.
5805 * TX and RX airtime can be reported together, or separately by setting one of
5806 * them to 0.
5807 *
5808 * @pubsta: the station
5809 * @tid: the TID to register airtime for
5810 * @tx_airtime: airtime used during TX (in usec)
5811 * @rx_airtime: airtime used during RX (in usec)
5812 */
5813 void ieee80211_sta_register_airtime(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid,
5814 u32 tx_airtime, u32 rx_airtime);
5815
5816 /**
5817 * ieee80211_txq_airtime_check - check if a txq can send frame to device
5818 *
5819 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
5820 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
5821 *
5822 * Return true if the AQL's airtime limit has not been reached and the txq can
5823 * continue to send more packets to the device. Otherwise return false.
5824 */
5825 bool
5826 ieee80211_txq_airtime_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
5827
5828 /**
5829 * ieee80211_iter_keys - iterate keys programmed into the device
5830 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
5831 * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all
5832 * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key
5833 * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function
5834 *
5835 * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to
5836 * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into
5837 * the device. This is intended for use in WoWLAN if the device
5838 * needs reprogramming of the keys during suspend. Note that due
5839 * to locking reasons, it is also only safe to call this at few
5840 * spots since it must hold the RTNL and be able to sleep.
5841 *
5842 * The order in which the keys are iterated matches the order
5843 * in which they were originally installed and handed to the
5844 * set_key callback.
5845 */
5846 void ieee80211_iter_keys(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5847 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5848 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5849 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5850 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5851 struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
5852 void *data),
5853 void *iter_data);
5854
5855 /**
5856 * ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu - iterate keys programmed into the device
5857 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
5858 * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all
5859 * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key
5860 * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function
5861 *
5862 * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to
5863 * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into
5864 * the device. Note that due to locking reasons, keys of station
5865 * in removal process will be skipped.
5866 *
5867 * This function requires being called in an RCU critical section,
5868 * and thus iter must be atomic.
5869 */
5870 void ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5871 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5872 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5873 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5874 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5875 struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
5876 void *data),
5877 void *iter_data);
5878
5879 /**
5880 * ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic - iterate channel contexts
5881 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5882 * @iter: iterator function
5883 * @iter_data: data passed to iterator function
5884 *
5885 * Iterate all active channel contexts. This function is atomic and
5886 * doesn't acquire any locks internally that might be held in other
5887 * places while calling into the driver.
5888 *
5889 * The iterator will not find a context that's being added (during
5890 * the driver callback to add it) but will find it while it's being
5891 * removed.
5892 *
5893 * Note that during hardware restart, all contexts that existed
5894 * before the restart are considered already present so will be
5895 * found while iterating, whether they've been re-added already
5896 * or not.
5897 */
5898 void ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic(
5899 struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5900 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5901 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *chanctx_conf,
5902 void *data),
5903 void *iter_data);
5904
5905 /**
5906 * ieee80211_ap_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template
5907 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5908 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5909 *
5910 * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to
5911 * hardware. The template is filled with bssid, ssid and supported rate
5912 * information. This function must only be called from within the
5913 * .bss_info_changed callback function and only in managed mode. The function
5914 * is only useful when the interface is associated, otherwise it will return
5915 * %NULL.
5916 *
5917 * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error.
5918 */
5919 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_ap_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5920 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5921
5922 /**
5923 * ieee80211_beacon_loss - inform hardware does not receive beacons
5924 *
5925 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5926 *
5927 * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER and
5928 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set, the driver needs to inform whenever the
5929 * hardware is not receiving beacons with this function.
5930 */
5931 void ieee80211_beacon_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5932
5933 /**
5934 * ieee80211_connection_loss - inform hardware has lost connection to the AP
5935 *
5936 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5937 *
5938 * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER, and
5939 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS and %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR are set, the driver
5940 * needs to inform if the connection to the AP has been lost.
5941 * The function may also be called if the connection needs to be terminated
5942 * for some other reason, even if %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR isn't set.
5943 *
5944 * This function will cause immediate change to disassociated state,
5945 * without connection recovery attempts.
5946 */
5947 void ieee80211_connection_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5948
5949 /**
5950 * ieee80211_disconnect - request disconnection
5951 *
5952 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5953 * @reconnect: immediate reconnect is desired
5954 *
5955 * Request disconnection from the current network and, if enabled, send a
5956 * hint to the higher layers that immediate reconnect is desired.
5957 */
5958 void ieee80211_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool reconnect);
5959
5960 /**
5961 * ieee80211_resume_disconnect - disconnect from AP after resume
5962 *
5963 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5964 *
5965 * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after resume.
5966 * Drivers can use this after WoWLAN if they know that the
5967 * connection cannot be kept up, for example because keys were
5968 * used while the device was asleep but the replay counters or
5969 * similar cannot be retrieved from the device during resume.
5970 *
5971 * Note that due to implementation issues, if the driver uses
5972 * the reconfiguration functionality during resume the interface
5973 * will still be added as associated first during resume and then
5974 * disconnect normally later.
5975 *
5976 * This function can only be called from the resume callback and
5977 * the driver must not be holding any of its own locks while it
5978 * calls this function, or at least not any locks it needs in the
5979 * key configuration paths (if it supports HW crypto).
5980 */
5981 void ieee80211_resume_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5982
5983 /**
5984 * ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify - inform a configured connection quality monitoring
5985 * rssi threshold triggered
5986 *
5987 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5988 * @rssi_event: the RSSI trigger event type
5989 * @rssi_level: new RSSI level value or 0 if not available
5990 * @gfp: context flags
5991 *
5992 * When the %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI is set, and a connection quality
5993 * monitoring is configured with an rssi threshold, the driver will inform
5994 * whenever the rssi level reaches the threshold.
5995 */
5996 void ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5997 enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event rssi_event,
5998 s32 rssi_level,
5999 gfp_t gfp);
6000
6001 /**
6002 * ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify - inform CQM of beacon loss
6003 *
6004 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6005 * @gfp: context flags
6006 */
6007 void ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, gfp_t gfp);
6008
6009 /**
6010 * ieee80211_radar_detected - inform that a radar was detected
6011 *
6012 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6013 */
6014 void ieee80211_radar_detected(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6015
6016 /**
6017 * ieee80211_chswitch_done - Complete channel switch process
6018 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6019 * @success: make the channel switch successful or not
6020 *
6021 * Complete the channel switch post-process: set the new operational channel
6022 * and wake up the suspended queues.
6023 */
6024 void ieee80211_chswitch_done(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool success);
6025
6026 /**
6027 * ieee80211_request_smps - request SM PS transition
6028 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6029 * @smps_mode: new SM PS mode
6030 *
6031 * This allows the driver to request an SM PS transition in managed
6032 * mode. This is useful when the driver has more information than
6033 * the stack about possible interference, for example by bluetooth.
6034 */
6035 void ieee80211_request_smps(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6036 enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode);
6037
6038 /**
6039 * ieee80211_ready_on_channel - notification of remain-on-channel start
6040 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6041 */
6042 void ieee80211_ready_on_channel(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6043
6044 /**
6045 * ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired - remain_on_channel duration expired
6046 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6047 */
6048 void ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6049
6050 /**
6051 * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session - callback to stop existing BA sessions
6052 *
6053 * in order not to harm the system performance and user experience, the device
6054 * may request not to allow any rx ba session and tear down existing rx ba
6055 * sessions based on system constraints such as periodic BT activity that needs
6056 * to limit wlan activity (eg.sco or a2dp)."
6057 * in such cases, the intention is to limit the duration of the rx ppdu and
6058 * therefore prevent the peer device to use a-mpdu aggregation.
6059 *
6060 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6061 * @ba_rx_bitmap: Bit map of open rx ba per tid
6062 * @addr: & to bssid mac address
6063 */
6064 void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 ba_rx_bitmap,
6065 const u8 *addr);
6066
6067 /**
6068 * ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames - move RX BA window and mark filtered
6069 * @pubsta: station struct
6070 * @tid: the session's TID
6071 * @ssn: starting sequence number of the bitmap, all frames before this are
6072 * assumed to be out of the window after the call
6073 * @filtered: bitmap of filtered frames, BIT(0) is the @ssn entry etc.
6074 * @received_mpdus: number of received mpdus in firmware
6075 *
6076 * This function moves the BA window and releases all frames before @ssn, and
6077 * marks frames marked in the bitmap as having been filtered. Afterwards, it
6078 * checks if any frames in the window starting from @ssn can now be released
6079 * (in case they were only waiting for frames that were filtered.)
6080 */
6081 void ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid,
6082 u16 ssn, u64 filtered,
6083 u16 received_mpdus);
6084
6085 /**
6086 * ieee80211_send_bar - send a BlockAckReq frame
6087 *
6088 * can be used to flush pending frames from the peer's aggregation reorder
6089 * buffer.
6090 *
6091 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6092 * @ra: the peer's destination address
6093 * @tid: the TID of the aggregation session
6094 * @ssn: the new starting sequence number for the receiver
6095 */
6096 void ieee80211_send_bar(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 *ra, u16 tid, u16 ssn);
6097
6098 /**
6099 * ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl - helper to queue an RX BA work
6100 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6101 * @addr: station mac address
6102 * @tid: the rx tid
6103 */
6104 void ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *addr,
6105 unsigned int tid);
6106
6107 /**
6108 * ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl - start a Rx BA session
6109 *
6110 * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including
6111 * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx
6112 * reordering.
6113 *
6114 * Create structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here
6115 * when they complete AddBa negotiation.
6116 *
6117 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6118 * @addr: station mac address
6119 * @tid: the rx tid
6120 */
6121 static inline void ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6122 const u8 *addr, u16 tid)
6123 {
6124 if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS))
6125 return;
6126 ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid);
6127 }
6128
6129 /**
6130 * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl - stop a Rx BA session
6131 *
6132 * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including
6133 * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx
6134 * reordering.
6135 *
6136 * Destroy structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here
6137 * when they complete DelBa negotiation.
6138 *
6139 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6140 * @addr: station mac address
6141 * @tid: the rx tid
6142 */
6143 static inline void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6144 const u8 *addr, u16 tid)
6145 {
6146 if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS))
6147 return;
6148 ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid + IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS);
6149 }
6150
6151 /**
6152 * ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired - stop a Rx BA session due to timeout
6153 *
6154 * Some device drivers do not offload AddBa/DelBa negotiation, but handle rx
6155 * buffer reording internally, and therefore also handle the session timer.
6156 *
6157 * Trigger the timeout flow, which sends a DelBa.
6158 *
6159 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6160 * @addr: station mac address
6161 * @tid: the rx tid
6162 */
6163 void ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6164 const u8 *addr, unsigned int tid);
6165
6166 /* Rate control API */
6167
6168 /**
6169 * struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control - rate control information for/from RC algo
6170 *
6171 * @hw: The hardware the algorithm is invoked for.
6172 * @sband: The band this frame is being transmitted on.
6173 * @bss_conf: the current BSS configuration
6174 * @skb: the skb that will be transmitted, the control information in it needs
6175 * to be filled in
6176 * @reported_rate: The rate control algorithm can fill this in to indicate
6177 * which rate should be reported to userspace as the current rate and
6178 * used for rate calculations in the mesh network.
6179 * @rts: whether RTS will be used for this frame because it is longer than the
6180 * RTS threshold
6181 * @short_preamble: whether mac80211 will request short-preamble transmission
6182 * if the selected rate supports it
6183 * @rate_idx_mask: user-requested (legacy) rate mask
6184 * @rate_idx_mcs_mask: user-requested MCS rate mask (NULL if not in use)
6185 * @bss: whether this frame is sent out in AP or IBSS mode
6186 */
6187 struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control {
6188 struct ieee80211_hw *hw;
6189 struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband;
6190 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *bss_conf;
6191 struct sk_buff *skb;
6192 struct ieee80211_tx_rate reported_rate;
6193 bool rts, short_preamble;
6194 u32 rate_idx_mask;
6195 u8 *rate_idx_mcs_mask;
6196 bool bss;
6197 };
6198
6199 /**
6200 * enum rate_control_capabilities - rate control capabilities
6201 */
6202 enum rate_control_capabilities {
6203 /**
6204 * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW:
6205 * Support for extended NSS BW support (dot11VHTExtendedNSSCapable)
6206 * Note that this is only looked at if the minimum number of chains
6207 * that the AP uses is < the number of TX chains the hardware has,
6208 * otherwise the NSS difference doesn't bother us.
6209 */
6210 RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW = BIT(0),
6211 /**
6212 * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_AMPDU_TRIGGER:
6213 * mac80211 should start A-MPDU sessions on tx
6214 */
6215 RATE_CTRL_CAPA_AMPDU_TRIGGER = BIT(1),
6216 };
6217
6218 struct rate_control_ops {
6219 unsigned long capa;
6220 const char *name;
6221 void *(*alloc)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6222 void (*add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, void *priv,
6223 struct dentry *debugfsdir);
6224 void (*free)(void *priv);
6225
6226 void *(*alloc_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, gfp_t gfp);
6227 void (*rate_init)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6228 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
6229 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta);
6230 void (*rate_update)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6231 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
6232 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
6233 u32 changed);
6234 void (*free_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6235 void *priv_sta);
6236
6237 void (*tx_status_ext)(void *priv,
6238 struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6239 void *priv_sta, struct ieee80211_tx_status *st);
6240 void (*tx_status)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6241 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
6242 struct sk_buff *skb);
6243 void (*get_rate)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
6244 struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control *txrc);
6245
6246 void (*add_sta_debugfs)(void *priv, void *priv_sta,
6247 struct dentry *dir);
6248
6249 u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(void *priv_sta);
6250 };
6251
6252 static inline int rate_supported(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6253 enum nl80211_band band,
6254 int index)
6255 {
6256 return (sta == NULL || sta->supp_rates[band] & BIT(index));
6257 }
6258
6259 static inline s8
6260 rate_lowest_index(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6261 struct ieee80211_sta *sta)
6262 {
6263 int i;
6264
6265 for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++)
6266 if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i))
6267 return i;
6268
6269 /* warn when we cannot find a rate. */
6270 WARN_ON_ONCE(1);
6271
6272 /* and return 0 (the lowest index) */
6273 return 0;
6274 }
6275
6276 static inline
6277 bool rate_usable_index_exists(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6278 struct ieee80211_sta *sta)
6279 {
6280 unsigned int i;
6281
6282 for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++)
6283 if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i))
6284 return true;
6285 return false;
6286 }
6287
6288 /**
6289 * rate_control_set_rates - pass the sta rate selection to mac80211/driver
6290 *
6291 * When not doing a rate control probe to test rates, rate control should pass
6292 * its rate selection to mac80211. If the driver supports receiving a station
6293 * rate table, it will use it to ensure that frames are always sent based on
6294 * the most recent rate control module decision.
6295 *
6296 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6297 * @pubsta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer to the target destination.
6298 * @rates: new tx rate set to be used for this station.
6299 */
6300 int rate_control_set_rates(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6301 struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
6302 struct ieee80211_sta_rates *rates);
6303
6304 int ieee80211_rate_control_register(const struct rate_control_ops *ops);
6305 void ieee80211_rate_control_unregister(const struct rate_control_ops *ops);
6306
6307 static inline bool
6308 conf_is_ht20(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6309 {
6310 return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20;
6311 }
6312
6313 static inline bool
6314 conf_is_ht40_minus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6315 {
6316 return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 &&
6317 conf->chandef.center_freq1 < conf->chandef.chan->center_freq;
6318 }
6319
6320 static inline bool
6321 conf_is_ht40_plus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6322 {
6323 return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 &&
6324 conf->chandef.center_freq1 > conf->chandef.chan->center_freq;
6325 }
6326
6327 static inline bool
6328 conf_is_ht40(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6329 {
6330 return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40;
6331 }
6332
6333 static inline bool
6334 conf_is_ht(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6335 {
6336 return (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5) &&
6337 (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10) &&
6338 (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT);
6339 }
6340
6341 static inline enum nl80211_iftype
6342 ieee80211_iftype_p2p(enum nl80211_iftype type, bool p2p)
6343 {
6344 if (p2p) {
6345 switch (type) {
6346 case NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION:
6347 return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT;
6348 case NL80211_IFTYPE_AP:
6349 return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO;
6350 default:
6351 break;
6352 }
6353 }
6354 return type;
6355 }
6356
6357 static inline enum nl80211_iftype
6358 ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
6359 {
6360 return ieee80211_iftype_p2p(vif->type, vif->p2p);
6361 }
6362
6363 /**
6364 * ieee80211_update_mu_groups - set the VHT MU-MIMO groud data
6365 *
6366 * @vif: the specified virtual interface
6367 * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group
6368 * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group
6369 *
6370 * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid and the position and
6371 * membership data is of the correct size and are in the same byte order as the
6372 * matching GroupId management frame.
6373 * Calls to this function need to be serialized with RX path.
6374 */
6375 void ieee80211_update_mu_groups(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6376 const u8 *membership, const u8 *position);
6377
6378 void ieee80211_enable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6379 int rssi_min_thold,
6380 int rssi_max_thold);
6381
6382 void ieee80211_disable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6383
6384 /**
6385 * ieee80211_ave_rssi - report the average RSSI for the specified interface
6386 *
6387 * @vif: the specified virtual interface
6388 *
6389 * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid.
6390 *
6391 * Return: The average RSSI value for the requested interface, or 0 if not
6392 * applicable.
6393 */
6394 int ieee80211_ave_rssi(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6395
6396 /**
6397 * ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup - report WoWLAN wakeup
6398 * @vif: virtual interface
6399 * @wakeup: wakeup reason(s)
6400 * @gfp: allocation flags
6401 *
6402 * See cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup().
6403 */
6404 void ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6405 struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup *wakeup,
6406 gfp_t gfp);
6407
6408 /**
6409 * ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb - prepare an 802.11 skb for transmission
6410 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6411 * @vif: virtual interface
6412 * @skb: frame to be sent from within the driver
6413 * @band: the band to transmit on
6414 * @sta: optional pointer to get the station to send the frame to
6415 *
6416 * Note: must be called under RCU lock
6417 */
6418 bool ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6419 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct sk_buff *skb,
6420 int band, struct ieee80211_sta **sta);
6421
6422 /**
6423 * ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap - Sanity-check and parse the radiotap header
6424 * of injected frames.
6425 *
6426 * To accurately parse and take into account rate and retransmission fields,
6427 * you must initialize the chandef field in the ieee80211_tx_info structure
6428 * of the skb before calling this function.
6429 *
6430 * @skb: packet injected by userspace
6431 * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device
6432 */
6433 bool ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap(struct sk_buff *skb,
6434 struct net_device *dev);
6435
6436 /**
6437 * struct ieee80211_noa_data - holds temporary data for tracking P2P NoA state
6438 *
6439 * @next_tsf: TSF timestamp of the next absent state change
6440 * @has_next_tsf: next absent state change event pending
6441 *
6442 * @absent: descriptor bitmask, set if GO is currently absent
6443 *
6444 * private:
6445 *
6446 * @count: count fields from the NoA descriptors
6447 * @desc: adjusted data from the NoA
6448 */
6449 struct ieee80211_noa_data {
6450 u32 next_tsf;
6451 bool has_next_tsf;
6452
6453 u8 absent;
6454
6455 u8 count[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX];
6456 struct {
6457 u32 start;
6458 u32 duration;
6459 u32 interval;
6460 } desc[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX];
6461 };
6462
6463 /**
6464 * ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa - initialize NoA tracking data from P2P IE
6465 *
6466 * @attr: P2P NoA IE
6467 * @data: NoA tracking data
6468 * @tsf: current TSF timestamp
6469 *
6470 * Return: number of successfully parsed descriptors
6471 */
6472 int ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa(const struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr *attr,
6473 struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf);
6474
6475 /**
6476 * ieee80211_update_p2p_noa - get next pending P2P GO absent state change
6477 *
6478 * @data: NoA tracking data
6479 * @tsf: current TSF timestamp
6480 */
6481 void ieee80211_update_p2p_noa(struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf);
6482
6483 /**
6484 * ieee80211_tdls_oper_request - request userspace to perform a TDLS operation
6485 * @vif: virtual interface
6486 * @peer: the peer's destination address
6487 * @oper: the requested TDLS operation
6488 * @reason_code: reason code for the operation, valid for TDLS teardown
6489 * @gfp: allocation flags
6490 *
6491 * See cfg80211_tdls_oper_request().
6492 */
6493 void ieee80211_tdls_oper_request(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *peer,
6494 enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper,
6495 u16 reason_code, gfp_t gfp);
6496
6497 /**
6498 * ieee80211_reserve_tid - request to reserve a specific TID
6499 *
6500 * There is sometimes a need (such as in TDLS) for blocking the driver from
6501 * using a specific TID so that the FW can use it for certain operations such
6502 * as sending PTI requests. To make sure that the driver doesn't use that TID,
6503 * this function must be called as it flushes out packets on this TID and marks
6504 * it as blocked, so that any transmit for the station on this TID will be
6505 * redirected to the alternative TID in the same AC.
6506 *
6507 * Note that this function blocks and may call back into the driver, so it
6508 * should be called without driver locks held. Also note this function should
6509 * only be called from the driver's @sta_state callback.
6510 *
6511 * @sta: the station to reserve the TID for
6512 * @tid: the TID to reserve
6513 *
6514 * Returns: 0 on success, else on failure
6515 */
6516 int ieee80211_reserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
6517
6518 /**
6519 * ieee80211_unreserve_tid - request to unreserve a specific TID
6520 *
6521 * Once there is no longer any need for reserving a certain TID, this function
6522 * should be called, and no longer will packets have their TID modified for
6523 * preventing use of this TID in the driver.
6524 *
6525 * Note that this function blocks and acquires a lock, so it should be called
6526 * without driver locks held. Also note this function should only be called
6527 * from the driver's @sta_state callback.
6528 *
6529 * @sta: the station
6530 * @tid: the TID to unreserve
6531 */
6532 void ieee80211_unreserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
6533
6534 /**
6535 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue
6536 *
6537 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6538 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from
6539 * ieee80211_next_txq()
6540 *
6541 * Returns the skb if successful, %NULL if no frame was available.
6542 *
6543 * Note that this must be called in an rcu_read_lock() critical section,
6544 * which can only be released after the SKB was handled. Some pointers in
6545 * skb->cb, e.g. the key pointer, are protected by RCU and thus the
6546 * critical section must persist not just for the duration of this call
6547 * but for the duration of the frame handling.
6548 * However, also note that while in the wake_tx_queue() method,
6549 * rcu_read_lock() is already held.
6550 *
6551 * softirqs must also be disabled when this function is called.
6552 * In process context, use ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni() instead.
6553 */
6554 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6555 struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
6556
6557 /**
6558 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue
6559 * (in process context)
6560 *
6561 * Like ieee80211_tx_dequeue() but can be called in process context
6562 * (internally disables bottom halves).
6563 *
6564 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6565 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from
6566 * ieee80211_next_txq()
6567 */
6568 static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6569 struct ieee80211_txq *txq)
6570 {
6571 struct sk_buff *skb;
6572
6573 local_bh_disable();
6574 skb = ieee80211_tx_dequeue(hw, txq);
6575 local_bh_enable();
6576
6577 return skb;
6578 }
6579
6580 /**
6581 * ieee80211_next_txq - get next tx queue to pull packets from
6582 *
6583 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6584 * @ac: AC number to return packets from.
6585 *
6586 * Returns the next txq if successful, %NULL if no queue is eligible. If a txq
6587 * is returned, it should be returned with ieee80211_return_txq() after the
6588 * driver has finished scheduling it.
6589 */
6590 struct ieee80211_txq *ieee80211_next_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac);
6591
6592 /**
6593 * ieee80211_txq_schedule_start - start new scheduling round for TXQs
6594 *
6595 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6596 * @ac: AC number to acquire locks for
6597 *
6598 * Should be called before ieee80211_next_txq() or ieee80211_return_txq().
6599 * The driver must not call multiple TXQ scheduling rounds concurrently.
6600 */
6601 void ieee80211_txq_schedule_start(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac);
6602
6603 /* (deprecated) */
6604 static inline void ieee80211_txq_schedule_end(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac)
6605 {
6606 }
6607
6608 /**
6609 * ieee80211_schedule_txq - schedule a TXQ for transmission
6610 *
6611 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6612 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
6613 *
6614 * Schedules a TXQ for transmission if it is not already scheduled,
6615 * even if mac80211 does not have any packets buffered.
6616 *
6617 * The driver may call this function if it has buffered packets for
6618 * this TXQ internally.
6619 */
6620 void ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
6621
6622 /**
6623 * ieee80211_return_txq - return a TXQ previously acquired by ieee80211_next_txq()
6624 *
6625 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6626 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
6627 * @force: schedule txq even if mac80211 does not have any buffered packets.
6628 *
6629 * The driver may set force=true if it has buffered packets for this TXQ
6630 * internally.
6631 */
6632 void ieee80211_return_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq,
6633 bool force);
6634
6635 /**
6636 * ieee80211_txq_may_transmit - check whether TXQ is allowed to transmit
6637 *
6638 * This function is used to check whether given txq is allowed to transmit by
6639 * the airtime scheduler, and can be used by drivers to access the airtime
6640 * fairness accounting without going using the scheduling order enfored by
6641 * next_txq().
6642 *
6643 * Returns %true if the airtime scheduler thinks the TXQ should be allowed to
6644 * transmit, and %false if it should be throttled. This function can also have
6645 * the side effect of rotating the TXQ in the scheduler rotation, which will
6646 * eventually bring the deficit to positive and allow the station to transmit
6647 * again.
6648 *
6649 * The API ieee80211_txq_may_transmit() also ensures that TXQ list will be
6650 * aligned against driver's own round-robin scheduler list. i.e it rotates
6651 * the TXQ list till it makes the requested node becomes the first entry
6652 * in TXQ list. Thus both the TXQ list and driver's list are in sync. If this
6653 * function returns %true, the driver is expected to schedule packets
6654 * for transmission, and then return the TXQ through ieee80211_return_txq().
6655 *
6656 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6657 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
6658 */
6659 bool ieee80211_txq_may_transmit(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6660 struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
6661
6662 /**
6663 * ieee80211_txq_get_depth - get pending frame/byte count of given txq
6664 *
6665 * The values are not guaranteed to be coherent with regard to each other, i.e.
6666 * txq state can change half-way of this function and the caller may end up
6667 * with "new" frame_cnt and "old" byte_cnt or vice-versa.
6668 *
6669 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
6670 * @frame_cnt: pointer to store frame count
6671 * @byte_cnt: pointer to store byte count
6672 */
6673 void ieee80211_txq_get_depth(struct ieee80211_txq *txq,
6674 unsigned long *frame_cnt,
6675 unsigned long *byte_cnt);
6676
6677 /**
6678 * ieee80211_nan_func_terminated - notify about NAN function termination.
6679 *
6680 * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function termination.
6681 * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq.
6682 *
6683 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6684 * @inst_id: the local instance id
6685 * @reason: termination reason (one of the NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_*)
6686 * @gfp: allocation flags
6687 */
6688 void ieee80211_nan_func_terminated(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6689 u8 inst_id,
6690 enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason reason,
6691 gfp_t gfp);
6692
6693 /**
6694 * ieee80211_nan_func_match - notify about NAN function match event.
6695 *
6696 * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function match. The
6697 * cookie inside the match struct will be assigned by mac80211.
6698 * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq.
6699 *
6700 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6701 * @match: match event information
6702 * @gfp: allocation flags
6703 */
6704 void ieee80211_nan_func_match(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6705 struct cfg80211_nan_match_params *match,
6706 gfp_t gfp);
6707
6708 /**
6709 * ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for RX.
6710 *
6711 * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the
6712 * rate information in the RX status struct and the frame length.
6713 *
6714 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6715 * @status: &struct ieee80211_rx_status containing the transmission rate
6716 * information.
6717 * @len: frame length in bytes
6718 */
6719 u32 ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6720 struct ieee80211_rx_status *status,
6721 int len);
6722
6723 /**
6724 * ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for TX.
6725 *
6726 * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the
6727 * rate information in the TX info struct and the frame length.
6728 *
6729 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6730 * @info: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
6731 * @len: frame length in bytes
6732 */
6733 u32 ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6734 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info,
6735 int len);
6736 /**
6737 * ieee80211_set_hw_80211_encap - enable hardware encapsulation offloading.
6738 *
6739 * This function is used to notify mac80211 that a vif can be passed raw 802.3
6740 * frames. The driver needs to then handle the 802.11 encapsulation inside the
6741 * hardware or firmware.
6742 *
6743 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6744 * @enable: indicate if the feature should be turned on or off
6745 */
6746 bool ieee80211_set_hw_80211_encap(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool enable);
6747
6748 /**
6749 * ieee80211_get_fils_discovery_tmpl - Get FILS discovery template.
6750 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6751 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6752 *
6753 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
6754 *
6755 * Return: FILS discovery template. %NULL on error.
6756 */
6757 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_get_fils_discovery_tmpl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6758 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6759
6760 /**
6761 * ieee80211_get_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_tmpl - Get unsolicited broadcast
6762 * probe response template.
6763 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6764 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6765 *
6766 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
6767 *
6768 * Return: Unsolicited broadcast probe response template. %NULL on error.
6769 */
6770 struct sk_buff *
6771 ieee80211_get_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_tmpl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6772 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6773
6774 /**
6775 * ieee80211_is_tx_data - check if frame is a data frame
6776 *
6777 * The function is used to check if a frame is a data frame. Frames with
6778 * hardware encapsulation enabled are data frames.
6779 *
6780 * @skb: the frame to be transmitted.
6781 */
6782 static inline bool ieee80211_is_tx_data(struct sk_buff *skb)
6783 {
6784 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info = IEEE80211_SKB_CB(skb);
6785 struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (void *) skb->data;
6786
6787 return info->flags & IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP ||
6788 ieee80211_is_data(hdr->frame_control);
6789 }
6790
6791 #endif /* MAC80211_H */